blob: ba20917272025237278c79b904cccac5c68339cf [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau9dc6b972019-06-16 21:49:47 +02005 version 2.1
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucb8f03f2019-10-01 18:13:09 +02007 2019/10/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200856. Cache
866.1. Limitation
876.2. Setup
886.2.1. Cache section
896.2.2. Proxy section
90
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001169.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200117
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011810. FastCGI applications
11910.1. Setup
12010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12110.1.2. Proxy section
12210.1.3. Example
12310.2. Default parameters
12410.3. Limitations
125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126
1271. Quick reminder about HTTP
128----------------------------
129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
132on almost anything found in the contents.
133
134However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
135formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
136correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
137
138
1391.1. The HTTP transaction model
140-------------------------------
141
142The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100143to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
145connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146will involve a new connection :
147
148 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
149
150In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
151establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
152by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
153length.
154
155Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
156to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
157however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
158response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
159header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
160
161 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
162
163Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
164power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
165but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200166a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100168Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
170second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
171page :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
176latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
177correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
178the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100179server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
182time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
183are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
184parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
185carry the stream identifier.
186
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
188connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
189leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
191processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
192waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200194HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100195 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
196 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100197 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100201For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
202the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100203server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
204is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
205servers.
206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
275received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
276processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
277as well as in server logs.
278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
295as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200598 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100599 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200600 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200601 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200603 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100606 - presetenv
607 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - uid
609 - ulimit-n
610 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200611 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200613 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200615 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - ssl-default-bind-options
617 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200618 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200619 - ssl-default-server-options
620 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100621 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100622 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100623 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100624 - 51degrees-data-file
625 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200626 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200627 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200628 - wurfl-data-file
629 - wurfl-information-list
630 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200631 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200634 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200636 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100637 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100638 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100639 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200640 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200641 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200642 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200643 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644 - noepoll
645 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000646 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100648 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300649 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000650 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100651 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200652 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200653 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200654 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000655 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000656 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - tune.buffers.limit
658 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200659 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200660 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100661 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200662 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200663 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200664 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100665 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200666 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200667 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100668 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100669 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100670 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100671 - tune.lua.session-timeout
672 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200673 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100674 - tune.maxaccept
675 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200676 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200677 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200678 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100679 - tune.rcvbuf.client
680 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100681 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200682 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100683 - tune.sndbuf.client
684 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100685 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100686 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200687 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100688 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200689 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200690 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100691 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200692 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100693 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200694 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
695 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
696 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100697 - tune.zlib.memlevel
698 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200700 * Debugging
701 - debug
702 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703
704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007053.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706------------------------------------
707
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200708ca-base <dir>
709 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200710 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
711 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713chroot <jail dir>
714 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
715 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
716 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
717 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
718 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100719 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100720
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100721cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
722 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
723 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
724 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
725 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
726 set. These sets have the format
727
728 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
729
730 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100731 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
733 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100734 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
735 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100736 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100737 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100738 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
741 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
742 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
743 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100744
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100745 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
746 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
747 on the machine's word size.
748
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100749 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
751 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
752 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
753 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
754 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
755 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100756
757 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
759
760 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
761 # first 4 CPUs
762
763 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
764 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
765 # word size.
766
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
770 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
771 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
772
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100773 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
774 # and so on.
775 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
776 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
777 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
778
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100780 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
781 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
782 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
783
784 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
786 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
787
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
789 # and a thread range.
790 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
791 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
792 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
793
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200794crt-base <dir>
795 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
796 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
797 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799daemon
800 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
801 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100802 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
803 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200805deviceatlas-json-file <path>
806 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100807 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200808
809deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100810 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200811 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
812
813deviceatlas-separator <char>
814 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
815 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
816
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100817deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200818 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
819 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
820 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100821
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900822external-check
823 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
824 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
825 See "option external-check".
826
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827gid <number>
828 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
829 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
830 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100831 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
832 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200833 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100834
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100835hard-stop-after <time>
836 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
837
838 Arguments :
839 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
840 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
841 SIGUSR1 signal.
842
843 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
844 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
845 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
846
847 Example:
848 global
849 hard-stop-after 30s
850
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200851h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
852 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
853 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
854 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
855 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
856 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
857 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
858 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
859 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
860 specified in a proxy.
861
862 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
863 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
864 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
865 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
866 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
867 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
868 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
869
870 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
871 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
872 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
873 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
874 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
875
876 Example:
877 global
878 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
879
880 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
881 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
882
883h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
884 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
885 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
886 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
887 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
888 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
889 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
890 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
891 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
892
893 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
894 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
895 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
896
897 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
898 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
899
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200900group <group name>
901 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
902 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100903
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200904log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
905 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100906 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100907 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100908 configured with "log global".
909
910 <address> can be one of:
911
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100912 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100913 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
914 port).
915
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100916 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
917 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
918 port).
919
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100920 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100921 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
922 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100923 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100924
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100925 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
926 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
927 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
928 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
929 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
930 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
931 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
932 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
933 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
934 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
935 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
936 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
937 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
938 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100939 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
940 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100941
942 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
943 "fd@2", see above.
944
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200945 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
946 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
947 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
948 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
949 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
950
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200951 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
952 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100953
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200954 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
955 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
956 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
957 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
958 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
959 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
960 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
961 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
962 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
963 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100964 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
965 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200966
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200967 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
968 one of the following :
969
970 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
971 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
972
973 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
974 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
975
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100976 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
977 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
978 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
979 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
980 logger consumes.
981
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100982 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
983 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
984 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
985 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
986
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200987 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
988 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
989 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
990 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
991 set with <sample_size> parameter.
992
993 <sample_size>
994 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
995 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
996 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
997 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
998 (see also <ranges> parameter).
999
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001000 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001001
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001002 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1003 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1004 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1005
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001006 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1007 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1008 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1009 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010
1011 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001012 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1013 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1014 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1015 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1016 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1017 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001018
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001019 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001021log-send-hostname [<string>]
1022 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1023 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1024 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1025 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1026 the logs.
1027
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001028log-tag <string>
1029 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1030 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1031 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001032 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001033
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001034lua-load <file>
1035 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1036 used multiple times.
1037
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001038master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001039 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1040 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1041 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001042 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001043 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1044 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001045 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1046 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1047 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1048 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1049 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001050
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001051 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001052
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001053mworker-max-reloads <number>
1054 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001055 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001056 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1057 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1058 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1059
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060nbproc <number>
1061 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1062 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1063 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001064 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1065 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001066 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1067 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001069nbthread <number>
1070 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001071 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1072 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1073 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1074 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1075 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001076 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1077 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1078 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1079 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1080 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1081 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1082 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001083
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001085 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1087 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1088
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001089presetenv <name> <value>
1090 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1091 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1092 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1093 and "unsetenv".
1094
1095resetenv [<name> ...]
1096 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1097 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1098 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1099 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1100 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1101 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1102 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1103 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1104
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001105stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001106 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1107 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1108 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1109 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1110 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1111 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001112 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001113 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1114 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1115 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1116 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001117
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001118server-state-base <directory>
1119 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001120 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1121 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001122
1123server-state-file <file>
1124 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1125 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1126 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1127 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1128 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1129 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1130 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1131 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001132 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1133 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001134
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001135setenv <name> <value>
1136 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1137 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1138 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1139 and "unsetenv".
1140
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001141set-dumpable
1142 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1143 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1144 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1145 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1146 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1147 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1148 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1149 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1150 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1151 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1152 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1153 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1154 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1155 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1156 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1157 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1158 expected when dying.
1159
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001160ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1162 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001163 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001164 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001165 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1166 information and recommendations see e.g.
1167 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1168 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1169 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1170 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001171
1172ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1174 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1175 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1176 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1177 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001178 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1179 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1180 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001181 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001182
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001183ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1185 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1186 keyword to see available options.
1187
1188 Example:
1189 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001190 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001191
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001192ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1194 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001195 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001196 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001197 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1198 information and recommendations see e.g.
1199 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1200 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1201 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1202 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1203 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001204
1205ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1206 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1207 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1208 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1209 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1210 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001211 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1212 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1213 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1214 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001215
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001216ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1217 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1218 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1219 keyword to see available options.
1220
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001221ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1223 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1224 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001225 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001226 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001227 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1228 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1229 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1230 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001231 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1232 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1233 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1234
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001235ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1236 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1237 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1238 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1239
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001240stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1241 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1242 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1243 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001244 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001245 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001246
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001247 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1248 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1249 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001250
1251stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1252 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1253 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001254 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001255
1256stats maxconn <connections>
1257 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1258 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1259
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001260uid <number>
1261 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1262 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1263 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1264 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1265
1266ulimit-n <number>
1267 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1268 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1269 option.
1270
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001271unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1272 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1273
1274 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1275 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1276 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1277 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1278 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1279 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1280 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1281 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1282 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1283 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1284
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001285unsetenv [<name> ...]
1286 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1287 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1288 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1289 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1290 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1291 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1292 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1293
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294user <user name>
1295 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1296 See also "uid" and "group".
1297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001298node <name>
1299 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1300
1301 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1302 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1303 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1304 traffic.
1305
1306description <text>
1307 Add a text that describes the instance.
1308
1309 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1310 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1311 "<" and ">" characters.
1312
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100131351degrees-data-file <file path>
1314 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001315 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001316
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001317 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001318 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1319
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000132051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001321 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1322 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1323 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1324
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001325 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001326 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1327
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200132851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001329 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1330 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1331
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001332 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1333 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1334
133551degrees-cache-size <number>
1336 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1337 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1338 By default, this cache is disabled.
1339
1340 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001341 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1342
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001343wurfl-data-file <file path>
1344 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1345 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1346
1347 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1348 with USE_WURFL=1.
1349
1350wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1351 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1352 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1353 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1354
1355 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1356
1357 Valid WURFL properties are:
1358 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1359
1360 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1361 device.
1362
1363 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1364 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1365
1366 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1367 particular web request.
1368
1369 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1370 used Libwurfl API version.
1371
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001372 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1373 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1374
1375 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1376 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1377
1378 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1379
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1381 with USE_WURFL=1.
1382
1383wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1384 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1385 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1386
1387 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1388 with USE_WURFL=1.
1389
1390wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1391 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1392 thus before the chroot.
1393
1394 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1395 with USE_WURFL=1.
1396
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001397wurfl-cache-size <size>
1398 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1399 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001400 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001401 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001402
1403 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1404 with USE_WURFL=1.
1405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014063.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001407-----------------------
1408
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001409busy-polling
1410 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1411 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1412 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1413 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1414 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1415 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1416 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1417 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1418 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1419 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1420 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1421 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1422 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1423 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1424 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1425 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1426 "poll" pollers.
1427
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001428max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1429 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1430 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1431 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1432 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1433 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1434 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1435 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1436 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1437
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001438maxconn <number>
1439 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1440 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1441 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001442 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1443 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1444 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1445 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001446 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1447 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1448 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1449 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1450 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1451 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001452
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001453maxconnrate <number>
1454 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1455 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1456 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1457 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1458 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1459 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1460 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1461 fairness.
1462
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001463maxcomprate <number>
1464 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001465 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001466 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1467 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1468 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001469 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001470 default value.
1471
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001472maxcompcpuusage <number>
1473 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1474 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1475 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1476 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1477 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1478 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1479 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1480 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1481
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001482maxpipes <number>
1483 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1484 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1485 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1486 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1487 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1488 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1489
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001490maxsessrate <number>
1491 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1492 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1493 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1494 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1495 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1496 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1497 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1498 fairness.
1499
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001500maxsslconn <number>
1501 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1502 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1503 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1504 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1505 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1506 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1507 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001508 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1509 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1510 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1511 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1512 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1513 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1514 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001515
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001516maxsslrate <number>
1517 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1518 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1519 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1520 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1521 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1522 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1523 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1524 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1525 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1526 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1527
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001528maxzlibmem <number>
1529 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1530 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1531 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001532 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1533 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1534 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001536noepoll
1537 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1538 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001539 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001540
1541nokqueue
1542 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1543 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1544 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1545
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001546noevports
1547 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1548 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1549 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1550 also "nopoll".
1551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001552nopoll
1553 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1554 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001555 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001556 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1557 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001558
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001559nosplice
1560 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001561 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001562 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001563 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001564 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1565 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1566 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1567 "option splice-response".
1568
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001569nogetaddrinfo
1570 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1571 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1572
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001573noreuseport
1574 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1575 command line argument "-dR".
1576
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001577profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1578 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1579 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1580 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1581 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001582 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001583 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1584 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1585 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1586 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1587
1588 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1589 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1590 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1591 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1592 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001593 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1594 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1595 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1596 CLI.
1597
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001598spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001599 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1600 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1601 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1602 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1603 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1604 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001605
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001606ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001607 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001608 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001609 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1610 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1611 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1612 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1613 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001614 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1615 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001616 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1617 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1618 openssl configuration file uses:
1619 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1620
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001621ssl-mode-async
1622 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001623 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001624 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1625 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1626 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001627 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001628 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001629
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001630tune.buffers.limit <number>
1631 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1632 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1633 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1634 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1635 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001636 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001637 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1638 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1639 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1640 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1641 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1642 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1643 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1644 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1645 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1646
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001647tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1648 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1649 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1650 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1651 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1652
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001653tune.bufsize <number>
1654 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1655 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1656 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1657 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1658 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1659 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1660 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001661 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1662 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1663 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001664 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001665 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1666 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1667 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001668
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001669tune.chksize <number>
1670 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1671 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1672 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1673 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1674 checks whenever possible.
1675
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001676tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1677 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1678 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1679 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1680 this value. The default value is 1.
1681
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001682tune.fail-alloc
1683 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1684 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1685 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1686 gracefully.
1687
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001688tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1689 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1690 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1691 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1692 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1693 change it.
1694
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001695tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1696 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001697 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1698 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001699 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1700 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1701 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1702 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1703 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1704
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001705tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1706 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1707 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1708 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1709 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1710 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1711 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1712 recommended not to change this value.
1713
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001714tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1715 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1716 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1717 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1718 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1719 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1720 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1721 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1722
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001723tune.http.cookielen <number>
1724 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1725 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1726 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1727 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1728 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1729 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1730 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1731 to change this value.
1732
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001733tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001734 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1735 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001736 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001737 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001738 configuration directives too.
1739 The default value is 1024.
1740
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001741tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1742 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1743 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1744 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1745 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1746 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1747 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001748 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1749 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1750 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001751
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001752tune.idletimer <timeout>
1753 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1754 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1755 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1756 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1757 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1758 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001759 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001760 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001761 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1762
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001763tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1764 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1765 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1766 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1767 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1768 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1769 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1770 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1771 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1772 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1773
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001774tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1775 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001776 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001777 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1778 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001780 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1781 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1782
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001783tune.lua.maxmem
1784 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1785 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1786 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1787 memory.
1788
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001789tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1790 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001791 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1792 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001794
1795tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1796 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1797 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1798 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1799 check servers.
1800
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001801tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1802 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1803 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1804 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001805 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001806
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001807tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001808 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1809 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1810 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1811 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1812 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1813 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1814 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1815 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1816 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1817 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001818
1819tune.maxpollevents <number>
1820 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1821 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1822 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1823 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1824 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1825
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001826tune.maxrewrite <number>
1827 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1828 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1829 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1830 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1831 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1832 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1833 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1834 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1835 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1836 bufsize.
1837
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001838tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1839 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1840 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1841 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1842 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1843 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1844 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1845 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1846 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1847 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1848 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1849 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1850 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1851 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1852 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1853 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1854 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1855 setting this parameter to 0.
1856
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001857tune.pipesize <number>
1858 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1859 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1860 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1861 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1862 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1863 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1864
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001865tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1866 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1867 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1868 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1869 default is 20.
1870
1871tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1872 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1873 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1874 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1875 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1876 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1877 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001878 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001879
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001880tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1881tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1882 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1883 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1884 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001885 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001886 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001887 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1888 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1889
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001890tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001891 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001892 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1893 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1894 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1895 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1896
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001897tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001898 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001899 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1900 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1901
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001902tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1903tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1904 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1905 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1906 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001907 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001908 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001909 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1910 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1911 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1912 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1913 notifying haproxy again.
1914
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001915tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001916 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1917 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1918 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001919 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001920 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001921 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001922 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1923 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1924 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001925 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1926 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001927
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001928tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001929 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001930 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1931 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1932 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1933 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1934 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1935
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001936tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1937 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001938 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001939 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1940 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1941 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1942 being used for too long.
1943
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001944tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1945 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1946 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1947 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1948 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1949 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1950 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1951 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1952 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1953 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1954 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001955 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001956 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001957
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001958tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1959 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1960 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1961 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1962 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1963 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1964 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1965 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001966 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1967 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001968
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001969tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1970 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1971 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1972 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1973 1000 entries.
1974
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001975tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1976 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1977 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1978 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1979
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001980tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001981tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001982tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1983tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1984tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001985 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1986 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1987 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1988 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1989 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1990 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1991 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1992 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001993
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001994 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1995 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1996 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1997 all available space is consumed.
1998 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1999 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2000 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002001
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002002tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2003 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002004 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002005 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002006 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002007 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2008
2009tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2010 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2011 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002012 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2013 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020153.3. Debugging
2016--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002017
2018debug
2019 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2020 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2021 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2022 system startup.
2023
2024quiet
2025 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2026 line argument "-q".
2027
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020293.4. Userlists
2030--------------
2031It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2032http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2033it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2034
2035userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002036 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002037 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2038
2039group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002040 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002041 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2042 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2043
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002044user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2045 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002046 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2047 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002048 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2049 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2050 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2051 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002052
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002053 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2054 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2055 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2056 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2057 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2058 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2059 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2060 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2061 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002062
2063 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002064 userlist L1
2065 group G1 users tiger,scott
2066 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002067
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002068 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2069 user scott insecure-password elgato
2070 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002071
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002072 userlist L2
2073 group G1
2074 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002075
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002076 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2077 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2078 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002079
2080 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002081
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002082
20833.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002084----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002085It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2086several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2087instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2088values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2089automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2090In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2091using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2092tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2093reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2094Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2095that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2096each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002097
2098peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002099 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002100 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2101
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002102bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2103 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2104 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2105
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002106disabled
2107 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2108 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2109 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2110
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002111default-bind [param*]
2112 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2113
2114default-server [param*]
2115 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2116
2117 Arguments:
2118 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2119 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2120 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2121 details.
2122
2123
2124 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2125
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002126enable
2127 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2128
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002129peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002130 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2131 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2132 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2133 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2134 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2135 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2136
2137 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2138 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2139
2140 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2141 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2142 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2143 across all peers.
2144
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002145 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2146 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002147
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002148 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2149 "server" keyword explanation below).
2150
2151server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002152 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002153 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2154 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2155 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2156 of this "peers" section).
2157 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2158
2159
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002160 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002161 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002162 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002163 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2164 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2165 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002166
2167 backend mybackend
2168 mode tcp
2169 balance roundrobin
2170 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2171 stick on src
2172
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002173 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2174 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002175
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002176 Example:
2177 peers mypeers
2178 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2179 default-server ssl verify none
2180 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2181 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002182
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002183
2184table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2185 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2186
2187 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2188 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002189 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002190 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2191 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2192 "stick-table" keyword).
2193
2194 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2195 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2196 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2197 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2198 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2199 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2200 of the stick-table name as follows:
2201
2202 peers mypeers
2203 peer A ...
2204 peer B ...
2205 table t1 ...
2206
2207 frontend fe1
2208 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2209
2210 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2211 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2212
2213 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2214 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2215 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2216 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2217 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2218 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2219 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2220
2221 peers mypeers
2222 peer A ...
2223 peer B ...
2224 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2225
2226 backend t1
2227 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2228
2229 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2230 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2231 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2232
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022333.6. Mailers
2234------------
2235It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2236If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2237in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2238
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002239mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002240 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2241 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2242
2243mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2244 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2245
2246 Example:
2247 mailers mymailers
2248 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2249 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2250
2251 backend mybackend
2252 mode tcp
2253 balance roundrobin
2254
2255 email-alert mailers mymailers
2256 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2257 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2258
2259 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2260 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2261
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002262timeout mail <time>
2263 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2264 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2265 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2266 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2267
2268 Example:
2269 mailers mymailers
2270 timeout mail 20s
2271 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002272
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022733.7. Programs
2274-------------
2275In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2276master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2277managed the same way as the workers.
2278
2279During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2280sequence as a worker:
2281
2282 - the master is re-executed
2283 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2284 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2285 instance of the program
2286
2287During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2288
2289program <name>
2290 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2291 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2292 the management guide).
2293
2294command <command> [arguments*]
2295 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2296 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2297 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2298 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2299
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002300user <user name>
2301 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2302 See also "group".
2303
2304group <group name>
2305 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2306 See also "user".
2307
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002308option start-on-reload
2309no option start-on-reload
2310 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2311 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2312 program section.
2313
2314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023154. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002316----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002317
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002318Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002319 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002320 - frontend <name>
2321 - backend <name>
2322 - listen <name>
2323
2324A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2325its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2326section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002327section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002328
2329A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2330connections.
2331
2332A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2333to forward incoming connections.
2334
2335A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2336parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2337
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002338All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2339'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2340case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2341
2342Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2343logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2344proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2345However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2346name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2347
2348Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2349and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002350bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002351protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2352modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2353arbitrary criteria.
2354
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002355In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2356a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002357the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002358
2359 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2360 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2361 between responses and new requests.
2362
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002363 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2364 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2365 client-facing connection remains open.
2366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002367 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2368 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002369
2370The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2371frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2372following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002373weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002374
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002375 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002376
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002377 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2378 ----+-----+-----+----
2379 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2380 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002381 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2382 ----+-----+-----+----
2383 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023874.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2388--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002390The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2391limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2392they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2393limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002394marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002395option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002396and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2397with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2398specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002400
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002401 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2402------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2403acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002404backlog X X X -
2405balance X - X X
2406bind - X X -
2407bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002408capture cookie - X X -
2409capture request header - X X -
2410capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002411compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002412cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002413declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002414default-server X - X X
2415default_backend X X X -
2416description - X X X
2417disabled X X X X
2418dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002419email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002420email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002421email-alert mailers X X X X
2422email-alert myhostname X X X X
2423email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002424enabled X X X X
2425errorfile X X X X
2426errorloc X X X X
2427errorloc302 X X X X
2428-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2429errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002430force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002431filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002432fullconn X - X X
2433grace X X X X
2434hash-type X - X X
2435http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002436http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002437http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002438http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002439http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002440http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002441http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002442id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002443ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002444load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002445log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002446log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002447log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002448log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002449max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002450maxconn X X X -
2451mode X X X X
2452monitor fail - X X -
2453monitor-net X X X -
2454monitor-uri X X X -
2455option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2456option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2457option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2458option allbackups (*) X - X X
2459option checkcache (*) X - X X
2460option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2461option contstats (*) X X X -
2462option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2463option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002464-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2465option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002466option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2467option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002468option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002469option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002470option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002471option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002472option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2474option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2475option httpchk X - X X
2476option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002477option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002478option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002479option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002480option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002481option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002482option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2483option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2484option logasap (*) X X X -
2485option mysql-check X - X X
2486option nolinger (*) X X X X
2487option originalto X X X X
2488option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002489option pgsql-check X - X X
2490option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002492option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002493option smtpchk X - X X
2494option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2495option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2496option splice-request (*) X X X X
2497option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002498option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002499option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2500option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2501-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002502option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002503option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2504option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2505option tcpka X X X X
2506option tcplog X X X X
2507option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002508external-check command X - X X
2509external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002510persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2511rate-limit sessions X X X -
2512redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002513-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002515retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002516server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002517server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002518server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002519source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002520stats admin - X X X
2521stats auth X X X X
2522stats enable X X X X
2523stats hide-version X X X X
2524stats http-request - X X X
2525stats realm X X X X
2526stats refresh X X X X
2527stats scope X X X X
2528stats show-desc X X X X
2529stats show-legends X X X X
2530stats show-node X X X X
2531stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002532-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2533stick match - - X X
2534stick on - - X X
2535stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002536stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002537stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002538tcp-check connect - - X X
2539tcp-check expect - - X X
2540tcp-check send - - X X
2541tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002542tcp-request connection - X X -
2543tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002544tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002545tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002546tcp-response content - - X X
2547tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002548timeout check X - X X
2549timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002550timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002551timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002552timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2553timeout http-request X X X X
2554timeout queue X - X X
2555timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002556timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002557timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002558timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002559transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002560unique-id-format X X X -
2561unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002562use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002563use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002564use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002565------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2566 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025694.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2570---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002571
2572This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2573
2574
2575acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2576 Declare or complete an access list.
2577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2578 no | yes | yes | yes
2579 Example:
2580 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2581 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2582 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002584 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002585
2586
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002587backlog <conns>
2588 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2590 yes | yes | yes | no
2591 Arguments :
2592 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2593 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002594 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002595
2596 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2597 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2598 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2599 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2600 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2601 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2602 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2603 backlog parameter.
2604
2605 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2606 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2607 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2608
2609 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2610
2611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002612balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002613balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2616 yes | no | yes | yes
2617 Arguments :
2618 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2619 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2620 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2621 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2622
2623 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2624 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2625 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2626 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002627 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002628 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002629 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2630 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2631 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2632 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2633 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2634 it, so that you don't worry.
2635
2636 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2637 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2638 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2639 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2640 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2641 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2642 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2643 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002644
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002645 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2646 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2647 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2648 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2649 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2650 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2651 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2652 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2653
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002654 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002655 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002656 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2657 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002658 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002659 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2660 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2661 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2662 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2663 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002664 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2665 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2666 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2667 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2668 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2669 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002670
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002671 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2672 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2673 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2674 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2675 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2676 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2677 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2678 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002679 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002681 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2682 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2683 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002684
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002685 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2686 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2687 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2688 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2689 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2690 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2691 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2692 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2693 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2694 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2695 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2696 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002697
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002698 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002699 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2700 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2701 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2702 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2703 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2704 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2705 URIs start with a leading "/".
2706
2707 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2708 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2709 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2710 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002713 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2714
2715 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002716 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2717 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002718 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2719 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2720 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2721 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002722 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002723 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2724 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002725
2726 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2727 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2728 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2729 server will receive the request.
2730
2731 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2732 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2733 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2734 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2735 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002736 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2737 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2738 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002739
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002740 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2741 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2742 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2743 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2744 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002746 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002747 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2748 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2749 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2750
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002751 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2752 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2753 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2754
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002755 random
2756 random(<draws>)
2757 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002758 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2759 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2760 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2761 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002762 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2763 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2764 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2765 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2766 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2767 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2768 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2769 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2770 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2771 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2772 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2773 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2774 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2775 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2776 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2777 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2778 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2779 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2780 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2781 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002782
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002783 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002784 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002785 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2786 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2787 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2788 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2789 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2790 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002791 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002792 used instead.
2793
2794 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2795 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2796 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2797 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2798
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002799 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2800 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2801 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2802
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002803 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002804
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002806 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2807 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002808
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002809 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2810 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2811 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002812
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002813 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002814 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002815 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2816 NTLM relies on.
2817
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002818 Examples :
2819 balance roundrobin
2820 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002821 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002822 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2823 balance hdr(host)
2824 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002825
2826 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2827 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002829 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002830 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2831 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2832 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002833 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002834
2835 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2836 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2837 defaults to 16 kB.
2838
2839 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2840 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2841
2842 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2843 Round Robin.
2844
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002845 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002846 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2847 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2848 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2849
2850 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2851
2852 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002853 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002854 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2855 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2856 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002858 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859
2860
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002861bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2862bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2865 no | yes | yes | no
2866 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002867 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2868 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2869 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2870 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002871 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002872 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2873 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2874 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2875 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2876 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2877 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2878 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002879 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2880 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2881 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2882 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2883 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2884 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2885 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002886 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2887 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2888 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002889 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2890 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2891 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2892 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002893 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2894 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2895 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002896
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002897 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2898 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002899 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2900 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2901 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002902 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2903 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2904 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2905 the range.
2906
2907 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2908 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2909 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2910 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2911 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2912 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2913 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002914 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002915 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002916
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002917 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002918 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002919 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2920 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2921 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2922 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2923 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2924 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2925
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002926 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2927 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2928 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2929 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2932 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2933 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2934 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2935 in a frontend.
2936
2937 Example :
2938 listen http_proxy
2939 bind :80,:443
2940 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002941 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002942
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002943 listen http_https_proxy
2944 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002945 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002946
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002947 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2948 bind ipv6@:80
2949 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2950 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2951
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002952 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002953 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002954
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002955 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2956 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2957 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2958 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2959 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2960
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002961 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002962 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002963
2964
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002965bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002966 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2968 yes | yes | yes | yes
2969 Arguments :
2970 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2971 may be used to override a default value.
2972
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002973 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002974 option may be combined with other numbers.
2975
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002976 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002977 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2978 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2979 missing from all processes.
2980
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002981 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002982 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002983 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2984 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2985 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2986 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2987 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002988 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002989
2990 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2991 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2992 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2993 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2994 and 'even' instances.
2995
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002996 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2997 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2998 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2999 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003000
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003001 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3002 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3003
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003004 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3005 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3006 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3007
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003008 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3009 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3010
3011 Example :
3012 listen app_ip1
3013 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003014 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003015
3016 listen app_ip2
3017 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003018 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003019
3020 listen management
3021 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003022 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003023
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003024 listen management
3025 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3026 bind-process 1-4
3027
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003028 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003029
3030
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003031capture cookie <name> len <length>
3032 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3034 no | yes | yes | no
3035 Arguments :
3036 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3037 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3038 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3039 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003040 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041
3042 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3043 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3044 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3045 right if it exceeds <length>.
3046
3047 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3048 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3049 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3050 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3051
3052 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3053 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3054 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3055
3056 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3057 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3058 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003059 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3060 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3061 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062
3063 Example:
3064 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3065
3066 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003067 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003068
3069
3070capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003071 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3073 no | yes | yes | no
3074 Arguments :
3075 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003076 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3078 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3079 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3080
3081 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3082 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3083 it exceeds <length>.
3084
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003085 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3087 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003088 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3089 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3090 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3091 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003092 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003093 environments to find where the request came from.
3094
3095 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3096 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3097 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3098 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003099
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003100 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3101 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3102 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3103 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3104 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105
3106 Example:
3107 capture request header Host len 15
3108 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003109 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003111 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112 about logging.
3113
3114
3115capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003116 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3118 no | yes | yes | no
3119 Arguments :
3120 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003121 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3123 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3124 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3125
3126 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3127 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3128 it exceeds <length>.
3129
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003130 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003131 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3132 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3133 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003134 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3135 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3136 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3137 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003139 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3140 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3141 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3142 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3143 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144
3145 Example:
3146 capture response header Content-length len 9
3147 capture response header Location len 15
3148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003149 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003150 about logging.
3151
3152
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003153compression algo <algorithm> ...
3154compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003155compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003156 Enable HTTP compression.
3157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3158 yes | yes | yes | yes
3159 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003160 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3161 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3162 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3163
3164 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003165 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3166 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3167 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003168
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003169 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003170 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003171
3172 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3173 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3174 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3175 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3176 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003177 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003178
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003179 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3180 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3181 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3182 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3183 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3184 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3185 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003186 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003187
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003188 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003189 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003190 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3191 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3192 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3193 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3194 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003195
3196 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3197 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3198 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3199 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3200 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003201 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3202 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3203 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3204 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3205 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003206 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3207 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003208
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003209 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003210 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3211 "Accept-Encoding" header
3212 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003213 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003214 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3215 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3216 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3217 "multipart"
3218 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3219 header
3220 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3221 and later
3222 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3223 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003224 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003225
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003226 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003227
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003228 Examples :
3229 compression algo gzip
3230 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003231
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003232
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003233cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003234 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3235 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003236 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003237 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3239 yes | no | yes | yes
3240 Arguments :
3241 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3242 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3243 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3244 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3245 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3246 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003247 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003248 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3249 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3250
3251 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3252 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3253 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3254 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3255 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3256 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003257 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3258 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003259 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003260 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3261 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003262
3263 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003264 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003265
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003266 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003267 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003268 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003269 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003270 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3271 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3272 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3273 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3274 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3275 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3276 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003277
3278 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3279 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3280 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3281 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3282 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3283 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3284 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3285 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3286 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003287 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003288 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3289 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3290 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003292 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3293 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3294 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003295 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3296 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3297 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3298 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003299 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3300 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3301 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003302
3303 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3304 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3305 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3306 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3307 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3308 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3309 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3310 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3311 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3312
3313 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3314 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3315 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3316 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3317 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3318 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3319 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3320 persistence cookie in the cache.
3321 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3322
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003323 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3324 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3325 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3326 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3327 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003328 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003329 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3330 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3331 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3332 they logout.
3333
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003334 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3335 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3336 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3337 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3338
3339 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3340 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3341 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3342 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3343 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3344 this attribute.
3345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003346 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003347 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003348 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3349 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3350 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3351 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3352 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3353 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003354
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003355 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3356 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3357 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3358 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3359 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3360 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3361 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3362 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003363 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003364 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3365 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3366 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3367 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3368 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3369 the site.
3370
3371 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3372 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3373 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3374 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3375 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3376 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3377 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3378 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3379 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3380 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3381 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3382 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3383 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003384 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003385 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3386 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3387
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003388 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3389 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3390 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3391 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3392 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3393 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3394
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3396 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3397 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3398 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003399
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003400 Examples :
3401 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3402 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3403 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003404 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003406 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003407
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003408
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003409declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3410 Declares a capture slot.
3411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3412 no | yes | yes | no
3413 Arguments:
3414 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3415
3416 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3417 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3418 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3419 for use in the response.
3420
3421 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003422 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003423 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3424
3425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003426default-server [param*]
3427 Change default options for a server in a backend
3428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3429 yes | no | yes | yes
3430 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003431 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3432 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3433 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3434 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003435
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003436 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003437 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3438
3439 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003440
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003441
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003442default_backend <backend>
3443 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3445 yes | yes | yes | no
3446 Arguments :
3447 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3448
3449 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3450 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3451 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3452 will catch all undetermined requests.
3453
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454 Example :
3455
3456 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3457 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3458 default_backend dynamic
3459
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003460 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003462
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003463description <string>
3464 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3466 no | yes | yes | yes
3467 Arguments : string
3468
3469 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3470 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3471 it describes.
3472 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3473
3474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003475disabled
3476 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3478 yes | yes | yes | yes
3479 Arguments : none
3480
3481 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3482 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3483 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3484 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3485 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3486 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3487 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3488
3489 See also : "enabled"
3490
3491
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003492dispatch <address>:<port>
3493 Set a default server address
3494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003496 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003497
3498 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3499 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3500 during start-up.
3501
3502 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3503 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3504 possible with normal servers.
3505
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003506 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003507 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3508 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3509 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3510 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3511
3512 See also : "server"
3513
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003514
3515dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3516 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3518 yes | no | yes | yes
3519 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3520
3521 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003522 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003523 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3524 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003525 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003526 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003527
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528enabled
3529 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3531 yes | yes | yes | yes
3532 Arguments : none
3533
3534 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3535 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3536
3537 See also : "disabled"
3538
3539
3540errorfile <code> <file>
3541 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3543 yes | yes | yes | yes
3544 Arguments :
3545 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003546 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3547 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003548
3549 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003550 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003551 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003552 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3553 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003554
3555 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3556 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3557 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3558
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003559 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003561 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3562 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3563 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3564 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3565
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003566 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3567 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003568 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003569 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3570 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3571 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3572
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003573 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3574 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3575 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003576 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003577 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3578
3579 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3580
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003581 Example :
3582 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003583 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003584 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3585 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3586
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003587
3588errorloc <code> <url>
3589errorloc302 <code> <url>
3590 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3592 yes | yes | yes | yes
3593 Arguments :
3594 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003595 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3596 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003597
3598 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3599 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3600 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3601 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003602 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003603
3604 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3605 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3606 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3607
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003608 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3609
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003610 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3611 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3612 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3613 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003614 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003615 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3616 request.
3617
3618 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3619
3620
3621errorloc303 <code> <url>
3622 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3624 yes | yes | yes | yes
3625 Arguments :
3626 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003627 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3628 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003629
3630 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3631 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3632 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3633 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003634 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003635
3636 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3637 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3638 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3639
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003640 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3641
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003642 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3643 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3644 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3645 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003646 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003647
3648 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3649
3650
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003651email-alert from <emailaddr>
3652 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003653 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3655 yes | yes | yes | yes
3656
3657 Arguments :
3658
3659 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3660
3661 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3662 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3663
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003664 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003665 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3666 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003667
3668
3669email-alert level <level>
3670 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3671 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3673 yes | yes | yes | yes
3674
3675 Arguments :
3676
3677 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3678 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3679 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3680
3681 By default level is alert
3682
3683 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3684 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3685 for the proxy.
3686
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003687 Alerts are sent when :
3688
3689 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3690 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3691 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3692 is notice or lower
3693 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3694 and a health check status update occurs
3695
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003696 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3697 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003698 section 3.6 about mailers.
3699
3700
3701email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3702 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3704 yes | yes | yes | yes
3705
3706 Arguments :
3707
3708 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3709
3710 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3711 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3712
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003713 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3714 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003715
3716
3717email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3718 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3719 mailers.
3720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3721 yes | yes | yes | yes
3722
3723 Arguments :
3724
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003725 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003726
3727 By default the systems hostname is used.
3728
3729 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3730 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3731 for the proxy.
3732
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003733 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3734 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003735
3736
3737email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003738 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003739 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3741 yes | yes | yes | yes
3742
3743 Arguments :
3744
3745 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3746
3747 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3748 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3749
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003750 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003751 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3752
3753
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003754force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3755 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3756 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003757 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003758
3759 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3760 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3761 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3762 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3763 marked down for maintenance operations.
3764
3765 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3766 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3767 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3768 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3769 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3770 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3771 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3772 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3773 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3774
3775 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3776 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3777 is used.
3778
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003779 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003780 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003781
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003782
3783filter <name> [param*]
3784 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3786 no | yes | yes | yes
3787 Arguments :
3788 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3789 referenced in section 9.
3790
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003791 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003792 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003793 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3794 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003795
3796 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3797 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3798
3799 Example:
3800 listen
3801 bind *:80
3802
3803 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3804 filter compression
3805 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3806
3807 compression algo gzip
3808 compression offload
3809
3810 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3811
3812 See also : section 9.
3813
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003814
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003815fullconn <conns>
3816 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3818 yes | no | yes | yes
3819 Arguments :
3820 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3821 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3822
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003823 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003824 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003825 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003826 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3827 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3828 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3829 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3830 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003831 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003832
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003833 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3834 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003835 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3836 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3837 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003838
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003839 Example :
3840 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3841 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3842 # connections.
3843 backend dynamic
3844 fullconn 10000
3845 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3846 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3847
3848 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3849
3850
3851grace <time>
3852 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003854 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003855 Arguments :
3856 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3857 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3858 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3859
3860 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3861 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003862 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003863 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3864
3865 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3866 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3867 simplify it.
3868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003869
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003870hash-balance-factor <factor>
3871 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3873 yes | no | no | yes
3874 Arguments :
3875 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3876 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003877 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003878
3879 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3880 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3881 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3882 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3883 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3884 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3885 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3886
3887 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3888 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3889 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3890 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3891 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3892
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003893 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3894 consistent hashing mechanism.
3895
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003896 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3897
3898
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003899hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003900 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3902 yes | no | yes | yes
3903 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003904 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3905 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003906
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003907 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3908 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3909 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3910 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3911 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3912 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3913 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3914 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3915 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3916 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003917
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003918 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3919 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3920 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3921 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3922 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3923 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3924 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3925 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3926 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3927 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3928 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3929 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3930 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003931 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3932 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003933
3934 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3935
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003936 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003937 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3938 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3939 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003940 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3941 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3942 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003943
3944 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3945 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003946 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3947 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3948 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3949 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3950
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003951 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3952 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3953 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3954 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3955 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3956 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3957 parameter.
3958
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003959 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3960 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3961 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3962 used on strings.
3963
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003964 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3965
3966 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3967 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3968 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3969 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3970 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3971 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3972 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3973 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3974 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3975 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3976 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3977 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003978
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003979 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3980 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3981 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003982
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003983 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003984
3985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003986http-check disable-on-404
3987 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003989 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003990 Arguments : none
3991
3992 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3993 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3994 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3995 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3996 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3997 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3998 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3999 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004000 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4001 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4002 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4003
4004 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4005
4006
4007http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004008 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004010 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004011 Arguments :
4012 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4013 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004014 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004015 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4016 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4017 details on the supported keywords.
4018
4019 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4020 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4021 with the usual backslash ('\').
4022
4023 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4024 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4025 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4026 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4027 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4028
4029 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004030 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004031 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4032 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4033 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4034
4035 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004036 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004037 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4038 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4039 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4040 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4041
4042 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004043 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004044 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4045 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4046 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4047 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4048 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004049 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004050 trace).
4051
4052 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004053 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004054 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4055 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4056 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4057 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4058 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004059 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004060
4061 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4062 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4063 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4064 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4065 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4066 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4067 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4068 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4069
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004070 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4071 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4072 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4073
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004074 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4075 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4076
4077 Examples :
4078 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004079 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004080
4081 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004082 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004083
4084 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004085 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004086
4087 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004088 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004089
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004090 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004091
4092
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004093http-check send-state
4094 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4096 yes | no | yes | yes
4097 Arguments : none
4098
4099 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4100 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4101 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4102 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4103 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4104
4105 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4106 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4107 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4108 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4109 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004110 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4111 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4112 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4113
4114 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4115 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4116 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4117
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004118 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4119 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4120 checked in multiple backends.
4121
4122 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4123 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4124
4125 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4126 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4127 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4128 one fails.
4129
4130 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4131 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4132 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4133
4134 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4135 server's queue.
4136
4137 Example of a header received by the application server :
4138 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4139 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4140
4141 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004143
4144http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004145 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4146
4147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4148 no | yes | yes | yes
4149
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004150 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4151 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4152 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4153 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4154 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004156 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4157 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004159 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161 Example:
4162 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4163 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4164 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004166 http-request allow if nagios
4167 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4168 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4169 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004171 Example:
4172 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4173 acl add path /addacl
4174 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004176 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004178 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4179 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004181 Example:
4182 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4183 acl setmap path /setmap
4184 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004185
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004186 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004188 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4189 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004191 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4192 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004194http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004196 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4197 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4198 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4199 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4200 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4201 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4202 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4203 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004207 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4208 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4209 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4210 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4211 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4212 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4213 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4214 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004216http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004218 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4219 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004220
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004222http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004224 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4225 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4226 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4227 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4228 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004230 Example:
4231 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4232 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004233
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004234http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004235
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004236 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004238http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4239 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4242 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4243 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4244 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4245 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4246 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4247 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4248 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4249 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004251 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4252 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4253 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4254 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4255 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4256 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004258http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004260 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4261 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4262 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4263 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4264 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4265 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004267http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004271http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004273 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4274 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4275 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4276 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4277 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4278 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4283 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4284 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4285 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4286 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004287
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004288http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4289 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4290 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4291 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4292
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004293http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4294
4295 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4296 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4297 pointed by <resolvers>.
4298 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4299 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4300 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4301 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4302 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4303 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4304 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4305 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4306 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4307 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4308 to 0.0.0.0.
4309
4310 Example:
4311 resolvers mydns
4312 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4313 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4314 timeout retry 1s
4315 hold valid 10s
4316 hold nx 3s
4317 hold other 3s
4318 hold obsolete 0s
4319 accepted_payload_size 8192
4320
4321 frontend fe
4322 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4323 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4324 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4325
4326 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4327 # which mean DNS resolution error
4328 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4329
4330 default_backend be
4331
4332 backend b_503
4333 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4334 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4335 # 503 error page to end users
4336
4337 backend be
4338 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4339 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4340 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4341 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4342 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4343
4344 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4345 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4346
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004347http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4348
4349 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4350 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4351 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4352 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004353 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4354 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004355
4356 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004358http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004360 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4361 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4362 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4363 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4364 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004366http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004368 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4369 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4370 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4371 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004373http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4377 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4378 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4379 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4380 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4381 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4382 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4383 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004384
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004385 Example:
4386 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004388 # applied to:
4389 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004391 # outputs:
4392 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004395
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004396http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4397 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4398
4399 This matches the regular expression in the URI part of the request
4400 according to <match-regex>, and replaces it with the <replace-fmt>
4401 argument. Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a
4402 number are supported. The <fmt> field is interpreted as a log-format string
4403 so it may contain special expressions just like the <fmt> argument passed
4404 to "http-request set-uri". The match is exclusively case-sensitive. Any
4405 optional scheme, authority or query string are considered in the matching
4406 part of the URI. It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more
4407 expensive to evaluate than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit
4408 from a condition to avoid performing the evaluation at all if it does not
4409 match.
4410
4411 Example:
4412 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4413 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
4414
4415 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4416 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4417
4418 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4419 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4420 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4421 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4424 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004426 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4427 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4428 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4429 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431 Example:
4432 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004434 # applied to:
4435 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004437 # outputs:
4438 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004440http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4441http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004442
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004443 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4444 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4445 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004446
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004447http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004449 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4450 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4451 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004452
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004453http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004455 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4456 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4457 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4458 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4459 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004461 Arguments:
4462 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4463 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004465 Example:
4466 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4467 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004468
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004469 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4470 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004471
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004472http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004474 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4475 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4476 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004478 Arguments:
4479 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4480 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482 Example:
4483 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4484 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004486 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4487 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4488 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004490http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4493 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4494 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4495 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4496 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004498 Example:
4499 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4500 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4501 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4502 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4503 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4504 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4505 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4506 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4507 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004509http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004511 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4512 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4513 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4514 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4515 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004517http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4518 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4521 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4522 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4523 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4524 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4525 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4526 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4527 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4528 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004532 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4533 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4534 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4535 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4536 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4537 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4538 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004540http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004542 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4543 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4544 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004548 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4549 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4550 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4551 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4552 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4553 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4554 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4555 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004559 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4560 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4561 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4562 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4563 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4564 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004566 Example :
4567 # prepend the host name before the path
4568 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004570http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004572 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4573 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4574 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4575 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4576 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004578http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004580 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4581 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4582 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4583 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4584 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4585 values have higher priority.
4586 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4587 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4588 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4589 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4590 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004592http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004594 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4595 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4596 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4597 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4598 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4599 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4600 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004602 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004603
4604 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004605 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4606 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004608http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4609 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4610 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4611 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4612 privacy.
4613
4614 Arguments :
4615 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4616 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004617
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004618 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4620 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4621
4622 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4623 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4624
4625http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4626
4627 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4628 expression.
4629
4630 Arguments:
4631 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4632 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004633
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004634 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004635 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4636 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4637
4638 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4639 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4640 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4641
4642http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4643
4644 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4645 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4646 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4647 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4648 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4649 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4650 information from the request.
4651
4652 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4653
4654http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4655
4656 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4657 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4658 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4659 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4660 path and the query string.
4661 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4662
4663http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4664
4665 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4666 inline.
4667
4668 Arguments:
4669 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4670 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4671 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4672 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4673 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4674 (request and response)
4675 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4676 processing
4677 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4678 processing
4679 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4680 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4681 and '_'.
4682
4683 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4684 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004685
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004686 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004687 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004689http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4690 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004692 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4693 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4694 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4695 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4696 agent name must be used.
4697
4698 Arguments:
4699 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4700
4701 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4702 configuration.
4703
4704http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4705
4706 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4707 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4708 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4709 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4710 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4711 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4712 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4713 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4714 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4715 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4716 action.
4717 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4718 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4719 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4720 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4721 you fully understand how it works.
4722
4723http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4724
4725 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4726 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4727 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4728 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4729 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4730 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4731 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4732 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4733 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4734 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4735 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4736 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4737 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4738
4739http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4740http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4741http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4742
4743 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4744 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4745 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4746 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4747 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4748 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4749 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4750 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4751 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4752 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4753 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4754 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4755
4756 Arguments :
4757 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4758 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4759 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4760 select which table entry to update the counters.
4761
4762 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4763 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4764 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4765 that table until the session ends.
4766
4767 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4768 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4769 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4770 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4771 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4772 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4773 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4774 useful information.
4775
4776 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4777 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4778 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4779 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4780 checks that make use of it.
4781
4782http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4783
4784 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004785
4786 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004787 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004788
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004789http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004791 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4792 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4793 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004794
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004796http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004797 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4798
4799 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 no | yes | yes | yes
4801
4802 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4803 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4804 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4805 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4806 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4807 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4808
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004809 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4810 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004811
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004812 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004814 Example:
4815 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004816
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004817 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004819 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4820 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004821
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004822 Example:
4823 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004824
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004825 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004827 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4828 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004830 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4831 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004833http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004834
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004835 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4836 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4837 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4838 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4839 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4840 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4841 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4842 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004843
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004844http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004846 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4847 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4848 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4849 example, or to pass some internal information.
4850 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4851 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4852 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004854http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004855
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004856 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4857 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004858
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004859http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004860
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004861 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004864
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004865 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4866 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4867 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4868 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4869 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4870 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4871 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004872
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004873 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4874 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4875 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4876 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4877 keyword.
4878 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4879 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004881http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4884 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4885 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4886 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4887 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4888 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004890http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004891
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004892 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004893
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004894http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004896 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4897 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4898 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4899 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4900 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4901 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004903http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004904
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004905 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4906 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004908http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004910 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4911 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4912 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4913 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4914 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4915 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004917http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4918 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004920 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4921 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4922 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4923 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4924 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4925 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4926 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4927 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004929 Example:
4930 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004932 # applied to:
4933 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004935 # outputs:
4936 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004938 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004940http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4941 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004942
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004943 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4944 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4945 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4946 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004948 Example:
4949 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004950
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004951 # applied to:
4952 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954 # outputs:
4955 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004957http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4958http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4961 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4962 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004964http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004966 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4967 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4968 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004970http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4973 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4974 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4975 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4976 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004978 Arguments:
4979 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004981 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4982 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004984http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004986 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4987 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4988 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004990http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4991
4992 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4993 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4994 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4995 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4996 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4997
4998http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4999
5000 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5001 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5002 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5003 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5004 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5005 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5006 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5007 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5008 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5009
5010http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5011
5012 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5013 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5014 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5015 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5016 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5017 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5018 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5019
5020http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5021
5022 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5023 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5024 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5025 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5026 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5027 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5028 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5029 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5030
5031http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5032 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5033
5034 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5035 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5036 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5037 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005038
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005039 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005040 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5041 http-response set-status 431
5042 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5043 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005045http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005047 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5048 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5049 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5050 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5051 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5052 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5053 based on some information from the request.
5054
5055 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5056
5057http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5058
5059 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5060 inline.
5061
5062 Arguments:
5063 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5064 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5065 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5066 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5067 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5068 (request and response)
5069 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5070 processing
5071 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5072 processing
5073 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5074 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5075 and '_'.
5076
5077 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5078 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005079
5080 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005081 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005083http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005085 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5086 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5087 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5088 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5089 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5090 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5091 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5092 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5093 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5094 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5095 action.
5096 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5097 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5098 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5099 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5100 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005102http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5103http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5104http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005105
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005106 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5107 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5108 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5109 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5110 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5111 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5112
5113http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5114
5115 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5116 about <var-name>.
5117
5118 Example:
5119 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5120
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005121
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005122http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5123 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5124
5125 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5126 yes | no | yes | yes
5127
5128 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005129 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5130 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5131 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005132
5133 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5134
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005135 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5136 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5137 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5138 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5139 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5140 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5141 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5142 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5143 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5144 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005145
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005146 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5147 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5148 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5149 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5150 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5151 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5152 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5153 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005154
5155 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5156 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5157 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5158 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5159 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5160 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5161 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5162 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005163 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005164 downsides of rare connection failures.
5165
5166 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5167 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5168 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5169 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5170 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5171 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005172 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005173 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5174 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5175 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5176 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5177 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5178
5179 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005180 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5181 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5182 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005183
5184 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005185 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005186
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005187 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5188 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005189
5190 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5191 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5192 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5193
5194 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5195 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5196 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5197
5198 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5199
5200
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005201http-send-name-header [<header>]
5202 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5204 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005205 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005206 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5207
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005208 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5209 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5210 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5211 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5212 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5213 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5214 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5215 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5216 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5217 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5218 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5219 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5220 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5221 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5222 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5223 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005224
5225 See also : "server"
5226
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005227id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005228 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5230 no | yes | yes | yes
5231 Arguments : none
5232
5233 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5234 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5235 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005236
5237
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005238ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5239 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005241 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005242
5243 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5244 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5245 and running).
5246
5247 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5248 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5249 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005250 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005251 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5252
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005253 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5254 "unless" condition is met.
5255
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005256 Example:
5257 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5258 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5259 ignore-persist if url_static
5260
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005261 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5262
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005263load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5264 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5266 yes | no | yes | yes
5267
5268 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5269 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5270 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005271 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005272 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5273 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5274 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5275 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5276
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005277 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005278 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005279 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005280
5281 Arguments:
5282 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5283 named "server-state-file".
5284
5285 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5286 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5287 name is used as a file name.
5288
5289 none don't load any stat for this backend
5290
5291 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005292 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5293 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5294 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005295 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005296 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005297
5298 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5299 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5300
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005301 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005302
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005303 global
5304 stats socket /tmp/socket
5305 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005306
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005307 defaults
5308 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005309
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005310 backend bk
5311 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5312 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005313
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005314
5315 Then one can run :
5316
5317 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5318
5319 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5320
5321 1
5322 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5323 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5324 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5325
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005326 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005327
5328 global
5329 stats socket /tmp/socket
5330 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5331
5332 defaults
5333 load-server-state-from-file local
5334
5335 backend bk
5336 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5337 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5338
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005339
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005340 Then one can run :
5341
5342 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5343
5344 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5345
5346 1
5347 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5348 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5349 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5350
5351 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5352 "show servers state"
5353
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005354
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005355log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005356log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5357 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005358no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005359 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5361 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005362
5363 Prefix :
5364 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5365 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5366 prefix does not allow arguments.
5367
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005368 Arguments :
5369 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5370 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5371 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5372 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5373 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5374 parameter.
5375
5376 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5377 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5378
5379 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5380 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5381 standard syslog port).
5382
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005383 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5384 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5385 standard syslog port).
5386
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005387 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5388 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5389 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005390 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005391
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005392 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5393 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5394 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5395 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5396 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5397 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5398 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5399 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5400 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5401 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5402 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5403 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5404 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5405 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5406 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5407 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005408 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5409 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005410
5411 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5412 and "fd@2", see above.
5413
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005414 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5415 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5416 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5417 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5418 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5419 having the logs instantly available.
5420
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005421 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5422 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005423
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005424 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5425 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5426 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5427 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5428 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5429 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5430 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5431 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5432 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5433 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005434 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005435
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005436 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5437 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5438 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5439 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5440 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5441
5442 <sample_size>
5443 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5444 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5445 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5446 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5447 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5448
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005449 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5450 one of the following :
5451
5452 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5453 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5454
5455 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5456 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5457
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005458 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5459 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5460 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5461 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5462 systemd logger consumes.
5463
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005464 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5465 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5466 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5467 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5468
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005469 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5470
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005471 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5472 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5473 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5474
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005475 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5476 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5477 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5478 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005479
5480 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5481 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5482 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005483 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5484 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5485 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5486 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5487 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005488
5489 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5490
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005491 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5492 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5493 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005494
5495 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5496 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5497 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5498 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5499
5500 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5501 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005502
5503 Example :
5504 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005505 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5506 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5507 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005508 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5509 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005510 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005512
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005513log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005514 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5515 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5516 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005517
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005518 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5519 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5520 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5521 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5522 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005523
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005524 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5525 "option httplog" directives.
5526
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005527log-format-sd <string>
5528 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5529 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5530 yes | yes | yes | no
5531
5532 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5533 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5534 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5535 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5536 which covers the log format string in depth.
5537
5538 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5539 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5540
5541 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5542 log format to "rfc5424".
5543
5544 Example :
5545 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5546
5547
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005548log-tag <string>
5549 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5551 yes | yes | yes | yes
5552
5553 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5554 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5555 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5556 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5557 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5558 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5559 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5560 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5561 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005562
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005563max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5564 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5565 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5566 yes | no | yes | yes
5567
5568 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5569 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5570 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5571 servers.
5572
5573 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5574 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5575 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5576 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5577 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005578 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005579 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5580 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5581 picking a different server.
5582
5583 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5584 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5585 even if they have to be queued.
5586
5587 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5588 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5589
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005590max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5591 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5592 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5593 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005594
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005595maxconn <conns>
5596 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5598 yes | yes | yes | no
5599 Arguments :
5600 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5601 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5602 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5603 closes.
5604
5605 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5606 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5607 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5608 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005609 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5610 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5611 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5612 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005613
5614 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5615 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5616 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5617
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005618 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5619 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005620
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005621 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5622
5623
5624mode { tcp|http|health }
5625 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5627 yes | yes | yes | yes
5628 Arguments :
5629 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5630 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5631 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5632 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5633
5634 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5635 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5636 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5637 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5638 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5639
5640 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005641 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5642 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5643 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5644 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5645 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5646 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5647 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005648
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005649 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5650 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5651 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005652
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005653 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005654 defaults http_instances
5655 mode http
5656
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005657 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005658
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005659
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005660monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005661 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5663 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005664 Arguments :
5665 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5666 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005667 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005668 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5669 backend and its backup.
5670
5671 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5672 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5673 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5674 servers in a list of backends.
5675
5676 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5677 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5678 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5679 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5680 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5681 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5682 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005683 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5684 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005685
5686 Example:
5687 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005688 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005689 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5690 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5691 monitor-uri /site_alive
5692 monitor fail if site_dead
5693
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005694 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005695
5696
5697monitor-net <source>
5698 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5700 yes | yes | yes | no
5701 Arguments :
5702 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5703 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5704 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5705 followed by a mask.
5706
5707 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5708 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005709 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005710 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5711
5712 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5713 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5714 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5715 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005716 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5717 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5718 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005719
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005720 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5721 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5722 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5723 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5724 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5725 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005726
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005727 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5728 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005729
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005730 Example :
5731 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5732 frontend www
5733 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5734
5735 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5736
5737
5738monitor-uri <uri>
5739 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5741 yes | yes | yes | no
5742 Arguments :
5743 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5744 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5745
5746 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5747 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5748 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5749 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5750 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5751 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5752 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5753 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5754
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005755 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005756 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5757 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5758 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5759 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5760 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5761 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005762
5763 Example :
5764 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5765 frontend www
5766 mode http
5767 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5768
5769 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005771
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005772option abortonclose
5773no option abortonclose
5774 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5776 yes | no | yes | yes
5777 Arguments : none
5778
5779 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5780 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5781 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5782 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005783 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005784 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5785 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5786 encountered while delivering the response.
5787
5788 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5789 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5790 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5791 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5792 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5793 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005794 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005795 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005796 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005797 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5798 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5799 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5800
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005801 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5802 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005803 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5804 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5805 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5806 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5807 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5808 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005809 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005810
5811 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5812 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5813
5814 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5815
5816
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005817option accept-invalid-http-request
5818no option accept-invalid-http-request
5819 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5821 yes | yes | yes | no
5822 Arguments : none
5823
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005824 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005825 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005826 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005827 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5828 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5829 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5830 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5831 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005832 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5833 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5834 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5835 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005836 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005837 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005838 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5839 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5840 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005841
5842 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5843 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5844 been confirmed.
5845
5846 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5847 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005848 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5849 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005850 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5851
5852 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5853 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5854
5855 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5856 stats socket.
5857
5858
5859option accept-invalid-http-response
5860no option accept-invalid-http-response
5861 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5863 yes | no | yes | yes
5864 Arguments : none
5865
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005866 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005867 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005868 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005869 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5870 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5871 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5872 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5873 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005874 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5875 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5876 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005877
5878 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5879 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5880 been confirmed.
5881
5882 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5883 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5884 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5885 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5886
5887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5889
5890 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5891 stats socket.
5892
5893
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005894option allbackups
5895no option allbackups
5896 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5898 yes | no | yes | yes
5899 Arguments : none
5900
5901 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5902 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5903 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5904 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5905 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5906 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5907 order between the backup servers anymore.
5908
5909 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5910 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5911
5912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5914
5915
5916option checkcache
5917no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005918 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | no | yes | yes
5921 Arguments : none
5922
5923 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5924 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005925 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005926 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5927 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005928 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005929
5930 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005931 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005932 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005933 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5934 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005935 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005936 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005937 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5938 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005939 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005940 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5941 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005942 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005943 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5944 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5945 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5946 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5947 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5948 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5949 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5950 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5951 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5952
5953 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005954 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
5955 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
5956 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
5957 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005958
5959 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5960 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005961 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005962 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005963
5964 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5965 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5966
5967
5968option clitcpka
5969no option clitcpka
5970 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5972 yes | yes | yes | no
5973 Arguments : none
5974
5975 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5976 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005977 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005978 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5979
5980 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5981 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5982 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5983 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5984
5985 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5986 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5987 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5988 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5989 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5990
5991 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5992
5993 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5994 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5995 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5996
5997 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5998 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5999
6000 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6001
6002
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006003option contstats
6004 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6006 yes | yes | yes | no
6007 Arguments : none
6008
6009 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6010 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6011 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6012 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006013 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6014 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6015 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6016 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6017 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006018
6019
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006020option dontlog-normal
6021no option dontlog-normal
6022 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6024 yes | yes | yes | no
6025 Arguments : none
6026
6027 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6028 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6029 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6030 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6031 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6032 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6033 logged.
6034
6035 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6036 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6037 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006039 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006040 logging.
6041
6042
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006043option dontlognull
6044no option dontlognull
6045 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6047 yes | yes | yes | no
6048 Arguments : none
6049
6050 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6051 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6052 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6053 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6054 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6055 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006056 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6057 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6058 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006059
6060 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006061 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006062 would not be logged.
6063
6064 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6065 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6066
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006067 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6068 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006069
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006070
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006071option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006072 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6074 yes | yes | yes | yes
6075 Arguments :
6076 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6077 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006078 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006079 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006080
6081 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6082 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6083 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6084 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6085 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6086 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6087 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006088 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6089 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6090 possible that the client has already brought one.
6091
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006092 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006093 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006094 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006095 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006096 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006097 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006098
6099 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6100 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6101 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6102 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6103 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6104 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6105 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6106
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006107 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6108 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6109 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6110 are under the control of the end-user.
6111
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006112 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006113 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6114 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006115 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6116 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6117 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006118
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006119 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006120 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6121 frontend www
6122 mode http
6123 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6124
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006125 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6126 backend www
6127 mode http
6128 option forwardfor header X-Client
6129
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006130 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006131 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006132
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006133
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006134option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6135no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6136 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6138 yes | yes | yes | no
6139 Arguments : none
6140
6141 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6142 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6143 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6144 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6145 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6146 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6147 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6148
6149 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6150 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6151 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6152 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6153 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6154 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6155 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6156 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6157 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6158 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6159
6160 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6161
6162 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6163 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6164
6165 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6166 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6167
6168
6169option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6170no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6171 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6173 yes | no | yes | yes
6174 Arguments : none
6175
6176 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6177 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6178 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6179 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6180 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6181 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6182 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6183
6184 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6185 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6186 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6187 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6188 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6189 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6190 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6191 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6192 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6193 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6194
6195 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6196
6197 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6198 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6199
6200 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6201 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6202
6203
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006204option http-buffer-request
6205no option http-buffer-request
6206 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6208 yes | yes | yes | yes
6209 Arguments : none
6210
6211 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6212 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6213 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6214 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6215 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6216 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6217 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6218 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006219 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006220 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6221 default.
6222
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006223 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006224
6225
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006226option http-ignore-probes
6227no option http-ignore-probes
6228 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6230 yes | yes | yes | no
6231 Arguments : none
6232
6233 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6234 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6235 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6236 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6237 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6238 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6239 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6240 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6241 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006242 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6243 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006244 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6245
6246 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6247 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6248 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6249 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6250 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6251 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6252 are often the only way to detect them.
6253
6254 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6255 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6256
6257 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6258
6259
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006260option http-keep-alive
6261no option http-keep-alive
6262 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6264 yes | yes | yes | yes
6265 Arguments : none
6266
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006267 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6268 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006269 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6270 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006271 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6272 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6273 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006274
6275 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6276 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006277 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6278 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6279 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6280 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6281 situations where this option may be useful :
6282
6283 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006284 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006285
6286 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6287 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6288
6289 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6290 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6291 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6292 request.
6293
6294 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6295 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006296 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6297 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6298 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006299
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006300 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6301 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6302 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6303 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6304 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6305 not set.
6306
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006307 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6308 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6309 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006310
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006311 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006312 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006313 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006314
6315
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006316option http-no-delay
6317no option http-no-delay
6318 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6320 yes | yes | yes | yes
6321 Arguments : none
6322
6323 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6324 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6325 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6326 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6327 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6328 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6329 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6330 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6331 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6332 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6333 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6334 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6335 affected.
6336
6337 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6338 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6339 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6340 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6341 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6342 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6343 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6344 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6345 latency environments.
6346
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006347 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6348
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006349
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006350option http-pretend-keepalive
6351no option http-pretend-keepalive
6352 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006354 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006355 Arguments : none
6356
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006357 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006358 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6359 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6360 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6361 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6362 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6363 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6364 consider the response complete.
6365
6366 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6367 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6368 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6369 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006370 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006371 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6372
6373 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6374 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6375 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6376 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6377 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6378 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6379 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6380
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006381 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6382 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6383 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6384 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6385 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6386 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006387
6388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6390
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006391 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006392 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006393
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006394
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006395option http-server-close
6396no option http-server-close
6397 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 yes | yes | yes | yes
6400 Arguments : none
6401
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006402 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6403 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6404 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6405 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006406 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6407 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6408 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6409 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6410 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6411 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6412 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6413 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6414 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6415 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6416 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006417
6418 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6419 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6420 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6421 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006422 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6423 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006424
6425 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6426 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006427 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6428 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6429 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006430
6431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6433
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006434 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6435 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006436
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006437option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006438no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006439 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6441 yes | yes | yes | no
6442 Arguments : none
6443
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006444 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006445 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6446 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6447 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6448 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6449 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6450 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6451
6452 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6453 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006454 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6455 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6456 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006457
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006458 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6459 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6460 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6461 front of an existing proxy.
6462
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006463 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6464
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006465 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006466
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006467option httpchk
6468option httpchk <uri>
6469option httpchk <method> <uri>
6470option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6471 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6473 yes | no | yes | yes
6474 Arguments :
6475 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6476 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6477 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6478 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6479 ones.
6480
6481 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6482 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6483 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6484
6485 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6486 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6487 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6488 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6489 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6490
6491 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6492 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6493 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6494 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6495 the lack of any response.
6496
6497 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6498
6499 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6500 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6501 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6502
6503 Examples :
6504 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6505 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6506 backend https_relay
6507 mode tcp
6508 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6509 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6510
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006511 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6512 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6513 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006514
6515
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006516option httpclose
6517no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006518 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6520 yes | yes | yes | yes
6521 Arguments : none
6522
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006523 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6524 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6525 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6526 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006527 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006528
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006529 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6530 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006531 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006532 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6533 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006534
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006535 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6536 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6537 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006538
6539 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6540 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006541 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6542 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6543 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006544
6545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6547
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006548 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006549
6550
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006551option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006552 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006554 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006555 Arguments :
6556 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6557 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6558 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006559 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006560 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006561
6562 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6563 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6564 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6565 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6566 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6567 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6568 ports.
6569
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006570 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6571 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006572
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006573 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006575 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006576
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006577
6578option http_proxy
6579no option http_proxy
6580 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6582 yes | yes | yes | yes
6583 Arguments : none
6584
6585 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6586 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6587 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6588 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6589 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6590
6591 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6592 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006593 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6594 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006595
6596 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6597 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6598
6599 Example :
6600 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6601 backend direct_forward
6602 option httpclose
6603 option http_proxy
6604
6605 See also : "option httpclose"
6606
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006607
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006608option independent-streams
6609no option independent-streams
6610 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6612 yes | yes | yes | yes
6613 Arguments : none
6614
6615 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6616 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6617 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6618 receive data or not.
6619
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006620 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006621 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6622 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6623 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6624 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6625 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6626 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6627 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6628 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6629 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6630 socket buffers.
6631
6632 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6633 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6634 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6635 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6636 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6637
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006638 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006639
6640
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006641option ldap-check
6642 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6644 yes | no | yes | yes
6645 Arguments : none
6646
6647 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6648 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6649 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6650 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6651
6652 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6653 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6654
6655 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6656 configure it.
6657
6658 Example :
6659 option ldap-check
6660
6661 See also : "option httpchk"
6662
6663
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006664option external-check
6665 Use external processes for server health checks
6666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6667 yes | no | yes | yes
6668
6669 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6670 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6671 command".
6672
6673 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6674
6675 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6676
6677
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006678option log-health-checks
6679no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006680 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6682 yes | no | yes | yes
6683 Arguments : none
6684
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006685 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6686 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6687 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006688
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006689 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6690 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6691 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6692 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6693 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6694
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006695 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006696 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006697
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006698 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6699 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6700 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006701
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006702
6703option log-separate-errors
6704no option log-separate-errors
6705 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6707 yes | yes | yes | no
6708 Arguments : none
6709
6710 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6711 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6712 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6713 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6714 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6715 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6716 provides very important information.
6717
6718 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6719 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6720 error logs.
6721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006722 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006723 logging.
6724
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006725
6726option logasap
6727no option logasap
6728 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6730 yes | yes | yes | no
6731 Arguments : none
6732
6733 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6734 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6735 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6736 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6737 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6738 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6739 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006740 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006741 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6742 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6743
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006744 Examples :
6745 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6746 mode http
6747 option httplog
6748 option logasap
6749 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6750
6751 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6752 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6753 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6754 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6755
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006756 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006757 logging.
6758
6759
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006760option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006761 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6763 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006764 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006765 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6766 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006767 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006768
6769 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6770 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006771 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006772 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6773 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6774 in the MySQL table, like this :
6775
6776 USE mysql;
6777 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6778 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6779
6780 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006781 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006782 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6783 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6784 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6785 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6786 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6787 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6788 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6789
6790 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6791 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006792
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006793 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006794
6795 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6796 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6797 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6798 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006799 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6800 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006801
6802 See also: "option httpchk"
6803
6804
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006805option nolinger
6806no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006807 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6809 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006810 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006811
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006812 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006813 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6814 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6815 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6816 connections.
6817
6818 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6819 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6820 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6821 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6822 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6823 this too.
6824
6825 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6826 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6827 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6828
6829 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6830 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6831 for servers.
6832
6833 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6834 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6835
6836
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006837option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6838 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6840 yes | yes | yes | yes
6841 Arguments :
6842 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6843 matching <network>
6844 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6845 header name.
6846
6847 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6848 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6849 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6850 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6851 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6852 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6853 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6854 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6855 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6856 possible that the client has already brought one.
6857
6858 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6859 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6860 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6861 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6862 header and requires different one.
6863
6864 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6865 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6866 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6867 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6868 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6869 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6870 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6871
6872 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6873 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6874 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6875 both are defined.
6876
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006877 Examples :
6878 # Original Destination address
6879 frontend www
6880 mode http
6881 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6882
6883 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6884 backend www
6885 mode http
6886 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6887
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006888 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006889
6890
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006891option persist
6892no option persist
6893 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6895 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006896 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006897
6898 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6899 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6900 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6901 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6902 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6903 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6904 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6905 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6906 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6907 redirected to another valid server.
6908
6909 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6910 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6911
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006912 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006913
6914
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006915option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6916 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 yes | no | yes | yes
6919 Arguments :
6920 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6921 PostgreSQL server.
6922
6923 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6924 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6925 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6926 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6927
6928 See also: "option httpchk"
6929
6930
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006931option prefer-last-server
6932no option prefer-last-server
6933 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6935 yes | no | yes | yes
6936 Arguments : none
6937
6938 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6939 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6940 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6941 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6942 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6943 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6944 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6945 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6946 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006947 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6948 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006949 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6950 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6951 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006952 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6953 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6954 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006955
6956 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6957 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6958
6959 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6960
6961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006962option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006963option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006964no option redispatch
6965 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6966 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6967 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006968 Arguments :
6969 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6970 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6971 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006972 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006973 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006974 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006975 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6976 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6977 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006979
6980 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6981 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6982 be able to access the service anymore.
6983
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006984 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6985 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006986
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006987 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006988 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6989 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006991 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6992 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6993
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006994 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006995
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006996
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006997option redis-check
6998 Use redis health checks for server testing
6999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7000 yes | no | yes | yes
7001 Arguments : none
7002
7003 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7004 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7005 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7006 find the "+PONG" response message.
7007
7008 Example :
7009 option redis-check
7010
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007011 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007012
7013
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007014option smtpchk
7015option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7016 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7018 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007019 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007020 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007021 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007022 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7023
7024 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7025 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7026 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7027
7028 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7029 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7030 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7031 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7032 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7033 dead server.
7034
7035 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7036 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007037 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007038 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7039
7040 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7041 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7042 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7043 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007044 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007045
7046 Example :
7047 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7048
7049 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007052option socket-stats
7053no option socket-stats
7054
7055 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7057 yes | yes | yes | no
7058
7059 Arguments : none
7060
7061
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007062option splice-auto
7063no option splice-auto
7064 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7066 yes | yes | yes | yes
7067 Arguments : none
7068
7069 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7070 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007071 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007072 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007073 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007074 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7075 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7076 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7077 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7078
7079 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7080 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7081 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7082 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7083 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7084 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7085 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7086 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7087 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7088 keyword.
7089
7090 Example :
7091 option splice-auto
7092
7093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7095
7096 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7097 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7098
7099
7100option splice-request
7101no option splice-request
7102 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7104 yes | yes | yes | yes
7105 Arguments : none
7106
7107 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007108 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007109 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7110 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7111 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7112 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7113
7114 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7115
7116 Example :
7117 option splice-request
7118
7119 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7120 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7121
7122 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7123 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7124
7125
7126option splice-response
7127no option splice-response
7128 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7130 yes | yes | yes | yes
7131 Arguments : none
7132
7133 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007134 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007135 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7136 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7137 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7138 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7139
7140 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7141
7142 Example :
7143 option splice-response
7144
7145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7147
7148 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7149 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7150
7151
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007152option spop-check
7153 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7155 no | no | no | yes
7156 Arguments : none
7157
7158 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7159 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7160 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7161 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7162
7163 Example :
7164 option spop-check
7165
7166 See also : "option httpchk"
7167
7168
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007169option srvtcpka
7170no option srvtcpka
7171 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7173 yes | no | yes | yes
7174 Arguments : none
7175
7176 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7177 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007178 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007179 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7180
7181 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7182 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7183 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7184 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7185
7186 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7187 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7188 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7189 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7190 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7191
7192 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7193
7194 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7195 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7196 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7197
7198 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7199 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7200
7201 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7202
7203
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007204option ssl-hello-chk
7205 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7207 yes | no | yes | yes
7208 Arguments : none
7209
7210 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7211 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7212 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7213 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7214 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7215 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7216 hello message.
7217
7218 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7219 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7220 messages, which is appreciable.
7221
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007222 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7223 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7224 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007225
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007226 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7227
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007228
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007229option tcp-check
7230 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7231 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 yes | no | yes | yes
7233
7234 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7235 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7236
7237 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7238 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7239 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7240
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007241 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007242 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7243 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7244 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7245 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7246 only.
7247
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007248 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007249 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7250 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7251 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7252 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7253
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007254 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007255 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7256 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007257 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007258 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7259 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7260 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7261 the respective protocols.
7262 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007263 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007264
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007265 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7266 script.
7267
7268 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7269 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7270 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7271 The "comment" is of course optional.
7272
7273
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007274 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007275 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007276 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007277 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007278
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007279 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007280 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007281 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007282
7283 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7284 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007285 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007286 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007287 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007288 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007289 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007290 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007291 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7292 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007293 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007294 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7295 tcp-check expect string +OK
7296
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007297 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007298 (send many headers before analyzing)
7299 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007300 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007301 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7302 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7303 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7304 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007305 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007306
7307
7308 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7309
7310
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007311option tcp-smart-accept
7312no option tcp-smart-accept
7313 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7315 yes | yes | yes | no
7316 Arguments : none
7317
7318 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7319 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7320 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7321 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7322 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7323 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7324
7325 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7326 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7327 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7328 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7329
7330 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7331 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7332 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007333 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007334
7335 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7336 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7337 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7338
7339 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7340 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7341 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7342
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007343 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7344
7345
7346option tcp-smart-connect
7347no option tcp-smart-connect
7348 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7350 yes | no | yes | yes
7351 Arguments : none
7352
7353 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7354 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7355 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7356 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7357 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7358
7359 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7360 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7361 complex.
7362
7363 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7364 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7365 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7366
7367 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7368 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7369
7370 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7371
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007372
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007373option tcpka
7374 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7376 yes | yes | yes | yes
7377 Arguments : none
7378
7379 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7380 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007381 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007382 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7383
7384 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7385 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7386 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7387 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7388
7389 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7390 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7391 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7392 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7393 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7394
7395 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7396
7397 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7398 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7399 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7400 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7401 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7402 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7403 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7404 backends.
7405
7406 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7407
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007408
7409option tcplog
7410 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007412 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007413 Arguments : none
7414
7415 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7416 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7417 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7418 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7419 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7420 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7421 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7422 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7423
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007424 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007426 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007427
7428
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007429option transparent
7430no option transparent
7431 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007433 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007434 Arguments : none
7435
7436 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7437 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7438 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7439 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7440 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7441 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7442 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7443 appropriate server.
7444
7445 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7446 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7447
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007448 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007449 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007450
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007451
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007452external-check command <command>
7453 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7455 yes | no | yes | yes
7456
7457 Arguments :
7458 <command> is the external command to run
7459
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007460 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7461
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007462 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007463
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007464 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7465 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7466 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7467 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7468 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7469 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007470
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007471 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7472
7473 Environment variables :
7474 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7475 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7476
7477 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7478
7479 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7480
7481 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7482 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7483 for a UNIX socket).
7484
7485 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7486
7487 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7488
7489 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7490
7491 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7492
7493 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7494
7495 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7496 socket).
7497
7498 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7499 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7500
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007501 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7502
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007503 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7504 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7505 failed.
7506
7507 Example :
7508 external-check command /bin/true
7509
7510 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7511
7512
7513external-check path <path>
7514 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7516 yes | no | yes | yes
7517
7518 Arguments :
7519 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7520
7521 The default path is "".
7522
7523 Example :
7524 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7525
7526 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7527 "external-check command"
7528
7529
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007530persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007531persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007532 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7534 yes | no | yes | yes
7535 Arguments :
7536 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007537 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7538 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007539
7540 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7541 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007542 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007543 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7544 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7545 forwarded to this server.
7546
7547 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7548 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7549 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007550 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007551 a single "listen" section.
7552
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007553 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7554 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7555 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7556
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007557 Example :
7558 listen tse-farm
7559 bind :3389
7560 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7561 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7562 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7563 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7564 persist rdp-cookie
7565 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007566 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007567 balance rdp-cookie
7568 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7569 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7570
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007571 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7572 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007573
7574
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007575rate-limit sessions <rate>
7576 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7578 yes | yes | yes | no
7579 Arguments :
7580 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7581 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7582
7583 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7584 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7585 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7586 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7587 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7588 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7589
7590 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7591 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7592 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7593 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7594
7595 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7596 listen smtp
7597 mode tcp
7598 bind :25
7599 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007600 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007601
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007602 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7603 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7604 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007605
7606 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7607
7608
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007609redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7610redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7611redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007612 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7614 no | yes | yes | yes
7615
7616 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007617 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007618
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007620 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007621 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7622 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7623 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007624
7625 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7626 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7627 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7628 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7629 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007630 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7631 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7632 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7633 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007634
7635 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7636 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7637 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7638 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7639 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7640 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007641 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007642 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007643 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7644 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7645 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007646
7647 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007648 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7649 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7650 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007651 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007652 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7653 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7654 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7655 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007656
7657 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007658 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007659
7660 - "drop-query"
7661 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7662 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7663 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7664 with a location-type redirect.
7665
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007666 - "append-slash"
7667 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7668 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7669 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7670 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7671
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007672 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7673 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7674 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7675 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7676 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7677 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7678 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7679
7680 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7681 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7682 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7683 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7684 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7685 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7686 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007687
7688 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7689 acl clear dst_port 80
7690 acl secure dst_port 8080
7691 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007692 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007693 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007694 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7695
7696 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007697 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7698 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7699 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007700 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007701
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007702 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7703 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7704 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7705
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007706 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007707 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007708
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007709 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007710 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7711 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7712 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007714 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007715
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007716
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007717retries <value>
7718 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7719 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7720 yes | no | yes | yes
7721 Arguments :
7722 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7723 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7724 default value is 3.
7725
7726 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7727 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7728 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7729
7730 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007731 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7732 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007733
7734 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7735 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7736
7737 See also : "option redispatch"
7738
7739
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007740retry-on [list of keywords]
7741 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7743 yes | no | yes | yes
7744 Arguments :
7745 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7746 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7747 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7748 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7749
7750 none never retry
7751
7752 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7753 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7754
7755 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7756 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7757 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7758 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7759 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7760 processing the request.
7761
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007762 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7763 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7764 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7765 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7766 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7767 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7768 overflow attack for example).
7769
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007770 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7771 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7772 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7773 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7774 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7775 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7776 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7777 amplify denial of service attacks.
7778
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007779 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7780 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7781 considered to be safe to retry.
7782
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007783 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7784 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7785 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7786 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7787
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007788 all-retryable-errors
7789 retry request for any error that are considered
7790 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7791 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7792 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7793
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007794 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7795 not cumulative.
7796
7797 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7798 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7799 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7800 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7801
7802 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7803 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7804 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7805 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7806 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7807 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7808 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7809 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7810 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7811 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7812 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7813 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7814
7815 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7816 should not use this directive.
7817
7818 The default is "conn-failure".
7819
7820 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7821
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007822server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007823 Declare a server in a backend
7824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7825 no | no | yes | yes
7826 Arguments :
7827 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007828 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007829 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007830
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007831 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7832 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7833 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7834 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007835 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7836 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7837 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7838 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7839 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007840 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7841 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7842 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7843 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7844 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7845 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7846 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007847 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007848 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7849 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7850 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7851 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7852 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7853 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007854 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7855 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007856 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7857 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007858
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007859 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007860 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7861 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7862 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7863 adding this value to the client's port.
7864
7865 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7866 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007867 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007868
7869 Examples :
7870 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7871 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007872 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007873 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7874 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7875 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007876
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007877 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7878 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7879 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7880 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7881 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7882
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007883 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7884 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007885
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007886server-state-file-name [<file>]
7887 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7888 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7889 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7890 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7891 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7892 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7893
7894 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7895 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7896
7897 global
7898 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7899
7900 backend bk
7901 load-server-state-from-file
7902
7903 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7904 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007905
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007906server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7907 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7908 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7910 no | no | yes | yes
7911
7912 Arguments:
7913 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7914
7915 <num | range>
7916 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7917 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7918 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7919 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7920
7921 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7922
7923 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7924
7925 <params*>
7926 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7927 keyword.
7928
7929 Examples:
7930 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7931 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7932 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7933
7934 # or
7935 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7936
7937 # would be equivalent to:
7938 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7939 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7940 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7941
7942
7943
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007944source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007945source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007946source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007947 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7949 yes | no | yes | yes
7950 Arguments :
7951 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7952 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007953
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007954 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007955 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7956 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7957 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7958 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7959 supported prefixes are :
7960 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7961 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7962 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007963 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007964 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7965 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007966
7967 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7968 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007969 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7970 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7971 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007972
7973 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7974 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7975 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7976 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7977 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7978 <addr>.
7979
7980 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7981 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7982 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7983 port.
7984
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007985 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7986 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7987 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7988 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007989 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007990 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7991 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7992 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7993 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7994 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7995 HTTP header.
7996
7997 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7998 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007999 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008000 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8001 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8002 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8003 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8004 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8005 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8006 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8007
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008008 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8009 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8010 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8011 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8012 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8013 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8014
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008015 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8016 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8017 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8018 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8019
8020 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8021 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8022 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8023 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8024 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8025 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8026
8027 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8028 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8029 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8030 there are two methods :
8031
8032 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8033 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8034 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8035 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8036 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8037 of the client ranges may be used.
8038
8039 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8040 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8041 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8042 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8043 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8044 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8045 same session.
8046
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008047 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8048 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8049 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008050 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008051
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008052 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8053
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008054 Examples :
8055 backend private
8056 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8057 source 192.168.1.200
8058
8059 backend transparent_ssl1
8060 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8061 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8062
8063 backend transparent_ssl2
8064 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8065 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8066 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8067
8068 backend transparent_ssl3
8069 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8070 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8071 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8072
8073 backend transparent_smtp
8074 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8075 # with Tproxy version 4.
8076 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8077
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008078 backend transparent_http
8079 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8080 # proxy.
8081 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008083 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008084 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8085
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008086
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008087stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8088 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008090 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008091
8092 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8093 matched.
8094
8095 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8096 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8097
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008098 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8099 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008100 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008101
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008102 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8103 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8104 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8105 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008106
8107 Example :
8108 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8109 backend stats_localhost
8110 stats enable
8111 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8112
8113 Example :
8114 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8115 backend stats_auth
8116 stats enable
8117 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8118 stats admin if TRUE
8119
8120 Example :
8121 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8122 userlist stats-auth
8123 group admin users admin
8124 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8125 group readonly users haproxy
8126 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8127
8128 backend stats_auth
8129 stats enable
8130 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8131 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8132 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8133 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8134
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008135 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8136 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8137 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008138
8139
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008140stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8141 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008143 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008144 Arguments :
8145 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8146
8147 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8148
8149 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8150 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8151 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8152 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8153 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8154 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8155
8156 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8157 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8158 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008159 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008160
8161 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8162 report using "stats scope".
8163
8164 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8165 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8166 unobvious parameters.
8167
8168 Example :
8169 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8170 backend public_www
8171 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8172 stats enable
8173 stats hide-version
8174 stats scope .
8175 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008176 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008177 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8178 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8179
8180 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8181 backend private_monitoring
8182 stats enable
8183 stats uri /admin?stats
8184 stats refresh 5s
8185
8186 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8187
8188
8189stats enable
8190 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008192 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008193 Arguments : none
8194
8195 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8196 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8197 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8198 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8199 - stats auth : no authentication
8200 - stats scope : no restriction
8201
8202 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8203 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8204 unobvious parameters.
8205
8206 Example :
8207 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8208 backend public_www
8209 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8210 stats enable
8211 stats hide-version
8212 stats scope .
8213 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008214 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008215 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8216 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8217
8218 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8219 backend private_monitoring
8220 stats enable
8221 stats uri /admin?stats
8222 stats refresh 5s
8223
8224 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8225
8226
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008227stats hide-version
8228 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008230 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008231 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008232
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008233 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8234 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8235 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8236 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8237 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8238 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008239
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008240 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8241 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8242 unobvious parameters.
8243
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008244 Example :
8245 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8246 backend public_www
8247 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008248 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008249 stats hide-version
8250 stats scope .
8251 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008252 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008253 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8254 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008255
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008256 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8257 backend private_monitoring
8258 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008259 stats uri /admin?stats
8260 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008261
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008262 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008263
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008264
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008265stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8266 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8267 Access control for statistics
8268
8269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8270 no | no | yes | yes
8271
8272 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8273 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8274 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8275 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8276 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8277 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8278
8279 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8280 instance.
8281
8282 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8283 about ACL usage.
8284
8285
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008286stats realm <realm>
8287 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008289 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008290 Arguments :
8291 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8292 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8293 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8294
8295 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8296 using a backslash ('\').
8297
8298 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8299 only related to authentication.
8300
8301 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8302 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8303 unobvious parameters.
8304
8305 Example :
8306 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8307 backend public_www
8308 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8309 stats enable
8310 stats hide-version
8311 stats scope .
8312 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008313 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008314 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8315 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8316
8317 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8318 backend private_monitoring
8319 stats enable
8320 stats uri /admin?stats
8321 stats refresh 5s
8322
8323 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8324
8325
8326stats refresh <delay>
8327 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008329 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008330 Arguments :
8331 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8332 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8333 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8334 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8335 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8336 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8337
8338 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8339 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8340 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8341 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8342
8343 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8344 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8345 unobvious parameters.
8346
8347 Example :
8348 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8349 backend public_www
8350 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8351 stats enable
8352 stats hide-version
8353 stats scope .
8354 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008355 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008356 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8357 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8358
8359 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8360 backend private_monitoring
8361 stats enable
8362 stats uri /admin?stats
8363 stats refresh 5s
8364
8365 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8366
8367
8368stats scope { <name> | "." }
8369 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008371 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008372 Arguments :
8373 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8374 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8375 section in which the statement appears.
8376
8377 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8378 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8379 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8380 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8381 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8382 exists.
8383
8384 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8385 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8386 unobvious parameters.
8387
8388 Example :
8389 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8390 backend public_www
8391 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8392 stats enable
8393 stats hide-version
8394 stats scope .
8395 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008396 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008397 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8398 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8399
8400 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8401 backend private_monitoring
8402 stats enable
8403 stats uri /admin?stats
8404 stats refresh 5s
8405
8406 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8407
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008408
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008409stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008410 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008412 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008413
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008414 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008415 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8416
8417 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8418 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8419
8420 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8421 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008422 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008423
8424 Example :
8425 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8426 backend private_monitoring
8427 stats enable
8428 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8429 stats uri /admin?stats
8430 stats refresh 5s
8431
8432 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8433 global section.
8434
8435
8436stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008437 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8439 yes | yes | yes | yes
8440 Arguments : none
8441
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008442 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008443 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8444 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8445 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8446 - IP (socket, server)
8447 - cookie (backend, server)
8448
8449 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8450 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008451 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008452
8453 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8454
8455
8456stats show-node [ <name> ]
8457 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008459 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008460 Arguments:
8461 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8462 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8463
8464 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8465 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008466 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008467
8468 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8469 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8470 unobvious parameters.
8471
8472 Example:
8473 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8474 backend private_monitoring
8475 stats enable
8476 stats show-node Europe-1
8477 stats uri /admin?stats
8478 stats refresh 5s
8479
8480 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8481 section.
8482
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008483
8484stats uri <prefix>
8485 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008487 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008488 Arguments :
8489 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8490 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8491 query string.
8492
8493 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8494 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8495 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8496 possible to reach it in the application.
8497
8498 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008499 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008500 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8501 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8502 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8503 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8504
8505 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8506 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8507 an address or a port to statistics only.
8508
8509 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8510 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8511 unobvious parameters.
8512
8513 Example :
8514 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8515 backend public_www
8516 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8517 stats enable
8518 stats hide-version
8519 stats scope .
8520 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008521 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008522 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8523 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8524
8525 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8526 backend private_monitoring
8527 stats enable
8528 stats uri /admin?stats
8529 stats refresh 5s
8530
8531 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8532
8533
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008534stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8535 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008537 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008538
8539 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008540 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008541 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008542 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008543 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8544
8545 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8546 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8547 the "stick-table" statement.
8548
8549 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8550 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8551 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8552 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8553 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8554
8555 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8556 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8557 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8558 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8559 transformation rules.
8560
8561 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8562 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8563 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8564 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8565 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8566 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8567 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8568
8569 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8570 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8571 ACL based conditions.
8572
8573 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8574 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8575 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8576 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8577
8578 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8579 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8580 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8581 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8582
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008583 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8584 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008585 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008586
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008587 Example :
8588 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8589 # last 30 minutes
8590 backend pop
8591 mode tcp
8592 balance roundrobin
8593 stick store-request src
8594 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8595 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8596 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8597
8598 backend smtp
8599 mode tcp
8600 balance roundrobin
8601 stick match src table pop
8602 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8603 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8604
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008605 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008606 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008607
8608
8609stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8610 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8612 no | no | yes | yes
8613
8614 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8615 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8616 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8617 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8618
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008619 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8620 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008621 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008622
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008623 Examples :
8624 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008625 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008626
8627 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8628 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8629 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8630
8631
8632 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8633 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8634 backend http
8635 mode http
8636 balance roundrobin
8637 stick on src table https
8638 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8639 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8640 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8641
8642 backend https
8643 mode tcp
8644 balance roundrobin
8645 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8646 stick on src
8647 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8648 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8649
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008650 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008651
8652
8653stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8654 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8656 no | no | yes | yes
8657
8658 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008659 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008660 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008661 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008662 server is selected.
8663
8664 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8665 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8666 the "stick-table" statement.
8667
8668 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8669 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8670 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8671 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8672 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8673 address.
8674
8675 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8676 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8677 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8678 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8679 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8680 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8681 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8682 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8683 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8684 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8685
8686 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8687 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8688 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8689 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8690 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8691 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8692 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8693
8694 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8695 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8696 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8697 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8698
8699 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8700 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8701 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8702 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8703 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8704 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008705 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8706 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8707 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8708 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8709 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8710 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008711
8712 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8713 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8714 the request.
8715
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008716 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8717 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008718 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008719
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008720 Example :
8721 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8722 # last 30 minutes
8723 backend pop
8724 mode tcp
8725 balance roundrobin
8726 stick store-request src
8727 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8728 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8729 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8730
8731 backend smtp
8732 mode tcp
8733 balance roundrobin
8734 stick match src table pop
8735 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8736 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8737
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008738 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008739 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008740
8741
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008742stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008743 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8744 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008745 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008747 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008748
8749 Arguments :
8750 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8751 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8752 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8753 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8754
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008755 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8756 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8757 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8758 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8759
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008760 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8761 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8762 instance.
8763
8764 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8765 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8766 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8767 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8768 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8769 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008770 to 32 characters.
8771
8772 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8773 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8774 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008775 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008776 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8777 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008778
8779 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008780 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8781 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008782 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8783 increase.
8784
8785 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008786 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8787 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8788 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008789
8790 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8791 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8792 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8793 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008794 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008795 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8796 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8797 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8798 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8799 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8800 parameter (see below).
8801
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008802 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8803 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8804 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8805 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8806 soft restart.
8807
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008808 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8809 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008810
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008811 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8812 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8813 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8814 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008815 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008816 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008817 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8818 if not expiration delay is specified.
8819
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008820 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8821 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8822 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8823 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008824 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8825 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8826 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8827 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8828 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8829 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8830 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8831 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8832 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8833 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8834 types and their arguments.
8835
8836 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8837 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8838 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8839 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8840
8841 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8842 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8843 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008844 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008845
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008846 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8847 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8848 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008849 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008850 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008851 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008852
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008853 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8854 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8855 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8856 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8857
8858 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8859 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8860 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8861 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8862 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8863 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8864
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008865 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8866 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8867 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8868 they were received.
8869
8870 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8871 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8872 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8873 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8874 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8875
8876 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8877 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8878 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8879 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8880 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8881
8882 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8883 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8884 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8885
8886 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8887 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8888 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8889 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8890 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8891
8892 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8893 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8894 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8895 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8896 the client side.
8897
8898 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8899 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8900 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8901 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8902 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8903 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8904 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8905
8906 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8907 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8908 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8909 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8910 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8911 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008912 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008913
8914 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8915 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8916 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8917 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8918 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8919 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8920
8921 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008922 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008923 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8924 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8925
8926 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8927 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8928 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8929 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8930 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8931 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8932 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8933 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8934 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8935 recommended for better fairness.
8936
8937 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008938 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008939 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8940 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8941
8942 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8943 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8944 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8945 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8946 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8947 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8948 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8949 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8950 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8951 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008952
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008953 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8954 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008955 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8956 reference it.
8957
8958 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8959 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008960 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8961 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8962 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008963
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008964 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8965 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8966 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8967 something that can be ignored.
8968
8969 Example:
8970 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8971 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8972 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8973 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8974
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008975 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008976 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008977
8978
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008979stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008980 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8982 no | no | yes | yes
8983
8984 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008985 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008986 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008987 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008988 server is selected.
8989
8990 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8991 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8992 the "stick-table" statement.
8993
8994 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8995 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8996 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8997 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8998
8999 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9000 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9001 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9002 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9003 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9004 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009005 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009006 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9007 rules.
9008
9009 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9010 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9011 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9012 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9013 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9014 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9015 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9016
9017 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9018 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9019 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9020 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9021
9022 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9023 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9024 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9025 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9026 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9027 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009028 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9029 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9030 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9031 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9032 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9033 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9034 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9035 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9036 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009037
9038 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9039
9040 Example :
9041 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9042 backend https
9043 mode tcp
9044 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009045 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009046 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009047
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009048 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9049 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9050
9051 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9052 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9053 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9054
9055 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9056 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009057
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009058 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9059 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9060 # at offset 44.
9061
9062 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9063 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9064
9065 # Learn on response if server hello.
9066 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009067
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009068 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9069 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9070
9071 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9072 extraction.
9073
9074
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009075tcp-check connect [params*]
9076 Opens a new connection
9077 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9078 no | no | yes | yes
9079
9080 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9081 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9082 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9083
9084 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9085 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9086 of the sequence.
9087
9088 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9089 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9090 do.
9091
9092 Parameters :
9093 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9094 use the TCP connection.
9095
9096 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9097 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9098 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9099
9100 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9101
9102 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9103
9104 Examples:
9105 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9106 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9107 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9108 option tcp-check
9109 tcp-check connect
9110 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9111 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9112 tcp-check send \r\n
9113 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9114 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9115 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9116 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9117 tcp-check send \r\n
9118 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9119 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9120
9121 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9122 option tcp-check
9123 tcp-check connect port 110
9124 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9125 tcp-check connect port 143
9126 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9127 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9128
9129 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9130
9131
9132tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009133 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009134 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9135 no | no | yes | yes
9136
9137 Arguments :
9138 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9139 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9140 binary.
9141 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9142 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9143 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9144
9145 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9146 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9147 with the usual backslash ('\').
9148 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009149 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009150 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9151 used upper or lower case.
9152
9153
9154 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9155
9156 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9157 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9158 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9159 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9160 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9161 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9162 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9163 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9164
9165 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9166 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9167 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9168 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9169 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9170 expression.
9171
9172 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9173 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9174 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9175 this exact hexadecimal string.
9176 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9177
9178 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9179 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9180 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9181 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9182 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9183 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9184 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9185 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9186 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9187 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9188 the null character.
9189
9190 Examples :
9191 # perform a POP check
9192 option tcp-check
9193 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9194
9195 # perform an IMAP check
9196 option tcp-check
9197 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9198
9199 # look for the redis master server
9200 option tcp-check
9201 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009202 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009203 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9204 tcp-check expect string role:master
9205 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9206 tcp-check expect string +OK
9207
9208
9209 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9210 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9211
9212
9213tcp-check send <data>
9214 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9215 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9216 no | no | yes | yes
9217
9218 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9219 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9220
9221 Examples :
9222 # look for the redis master server
9223 option tcp-check
9224 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9225 tcp-check expect string role:master
9226
9227 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9228 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9229
9230
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009231tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9232 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009233 tcp health check
9234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9235 no | no | yes | yes
9236
9237 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9238 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009239 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009240 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9241 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9242 hexadecimal string.
9243 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9244
9245 Examples :
9246 # redis check in binary
9247 option tcp-check
9248 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9249 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9250
9251
9252 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9253 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9254
9255
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009256tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9257 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9259 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009260 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009261 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9262 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009263
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009264 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009265
9266 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9267 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009268 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9269 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9270 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9271 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9272 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9273 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009275 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9276 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9277 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9278 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009279
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009280 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009281 - accept :
9282 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9283 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9284 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009286 - reject :
9287 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9288 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9289 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9290 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9291 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9292 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9293 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9294 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9295 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9296 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9297 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009298 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009299
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009300 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9301 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9302 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9303 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9304 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9305 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9306 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9307 hosts.
9308
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009309 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9310 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9311 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9312 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9313 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9314 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9315 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9316 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9317
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009318 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9319 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9320 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9321 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9322 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9323 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9324 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9325 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9326 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009327 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9328 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009329
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009330 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009331 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009332 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9333 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9334 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009335 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009336 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9337 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9338 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9339 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9340 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9341 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9342 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9343 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009344
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009345 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009346 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009347 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009348 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009349 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9350 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9351 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009352
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009353 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9354 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9355 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9356 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009357
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009358 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9359 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9360 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9361 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9362 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009363 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9364 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9365 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9366 layer7 information is extracted.
9367
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009368 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9369 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9370 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9371 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9372 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009373
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009374 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9375 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9376 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9377 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9378
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009379 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9380 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9381 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9382 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9383
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009384 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9385 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9386 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9387 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9388 continues.
9389
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009390 - set-src <expr> :
9391 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9392 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9393 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009394 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009395
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009396 Arguments:
9397 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9398 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009399
9400 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009401 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9402
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009403 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9404 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009405
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009406 - set-src-port <expr> :
9407 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9408 expression.
9409
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009410 Arguments:
9411 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9412 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009413
9414 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009415 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9416
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009417 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9418 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9419 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009420
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009421 - set-dst <expr> :
9422 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9423 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9424 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9425 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9426 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9427
9428 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9429 followed by some converters.
9430
9431 Example:
9432
9433 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9434 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9435
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009436 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9437 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9438
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009439 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9440 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9441 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9442 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9443
9444
9445 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9446 followed by some converters.
9447
9448 Example:
9449
9450 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9451
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009452 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9453 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9454 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9455
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009456 - "silent-drop" :
9457 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009458 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009459 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9460 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9461 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9462 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9463 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009464 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9465 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009466 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9467 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009468 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009469 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9470 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9471 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9472 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9473
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009474 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9475 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9476 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009477
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009478 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9479 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9480 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009481
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009482 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009483 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009484 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009485
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009486 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9487 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9488 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009489
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009490 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009491 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9492 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009493
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009494 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9495
9496 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9497
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009498 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9499
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009500 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009501
9502
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009503tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9504 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009506 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009507 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009508 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9509 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009510
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009511 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009512
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009513 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009514 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9515 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9516 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9517 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009518
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009519 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9520 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9521 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9522 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009523 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9524 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9525 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9526 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9527 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9528 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009529 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009530 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009531
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009532 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9533 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9534 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9535 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009536
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009537 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009538 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009539 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009540 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9541 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009542 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009543 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009544 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009545 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009546 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009547 - set-dst <expr>
9548 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009549 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009550 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009551 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009552 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009553
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009554 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9555 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009556 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9557 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009558
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009559 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9560 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9561 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9562 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9563 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9564 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009566 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009567 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9568 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009569
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009570 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009571 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9572 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9573 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9574 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009575 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9576 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9577 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009578
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009579 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009580 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9581 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9582 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009583
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009584 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9585 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9586
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009587 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009588 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9589 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009590
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009591 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9592 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009593 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009594 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9595 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009596 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009597 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009598 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009599 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9600 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009601 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009602 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9603 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009604
9605 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9606 followed by some converters.
9607
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009608 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9609 <var-name>.
9610
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009611 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9612 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9613 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9614 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9615 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9616
9617 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9618 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9619 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9620 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9621 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9622 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9623 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9624 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9625 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9626 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9627 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9628
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009629 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9630 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9631 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9632 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9633 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9634
9635 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9636
9637 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9638
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009639 Example:
9640
9641 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009642 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009643
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009644 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009645 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9646 # and reject everything else.
9647 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9648 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009649 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009650 tcp-request content reject
9651
9652 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009653 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9654 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9655 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009656 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009657
9658 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9659 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9660 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009661 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009662 tcp-request content reject
9663
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009664 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009665 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009666 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009667 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009668 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9669 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009670
9671 Example:
9672 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9673 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009674 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009675
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009676 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009677 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009678
9679 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009680 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009681 # protecting all our sites
9682 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009683 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9684 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009685 ...
9686 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9687
9688 backend http_dynamic
9689 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009690 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009691 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009692 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009693 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009694 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009695 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009697 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009698
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009699 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9700 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009701
9702
9703tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9704 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009706 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009707 Arguments :
9708 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9709 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9710 as explained at the top of this document.
9711
9712 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9713 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9714 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9715 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9716 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9717
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009718 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9719 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9720 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9721 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9722
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009723 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9724 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009725 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009726 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009727 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9728 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9729 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9730 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009731
9732 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9733 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9734 it pass through unaffected.
9735
9736 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9737 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9738 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009739 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009740 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9741 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009742 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9743 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9744 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009745
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009746 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009747 "timeout client".
9748
9749
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009750tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9751 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9753 no | no | yes | yes
9754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009755 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9756 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009757
9758 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9759
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009760 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009761 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9762 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009763 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9764 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009765
9766 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9767
9768 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9769 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9770 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9771 inserted.
9772
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009773 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009774 - accept :
9775 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9776 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9777 the rules evaluation.
9778
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009779 - close :
9780 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9781 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9782 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9783 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9784 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9785 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009786 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009787 protocols.
9788
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009789 - reject :
9790 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9791 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009792 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009793
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009794 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9795 Sets a variable.
9796
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009797 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9798 Unsets a variable.
9799
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009800 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9801 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9802 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9803 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9804
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009805 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9806 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9807 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9808 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9809
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009810 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9811 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9812 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9813 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9814 continues.
9815
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009816 - "silent-drop" :
9817 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009818 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009819 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9820 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9821 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9822 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9823 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009824 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9825 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009826 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9827 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009828 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009829 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9830 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9831 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9832 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9833
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009834 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9835 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9836
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009837 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9838 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9839 for changing the default action to a reject.
9840
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009841 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9842 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9843 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9844 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009845 period.
9846
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009847 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9848 declared inline.
9849
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009850 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9851 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009852 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009853 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9854 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009855 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009856 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009857 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009858 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9859 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009860 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009861 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9862 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009863
9864 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9865 followed by some converters.
9866
9867 Example:
9868
9869 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9870
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009871 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9872 <var-name>.
9873
9874 Example:
9875
9876 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9877
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009878 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9879 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9880 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9881 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9882 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9883
9884 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9885
9886 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9887
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009888 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9889
9890 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9891
9892
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009893tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9894 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9896 no | yes | yes | no
9897 Arguments :
9898 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9899 below.
9900
9901 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9902
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009903 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009904 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9905 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9906 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9907 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9908 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9909 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9910 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009911 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009912 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9913 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9914 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9915 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9916 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9917 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9918 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9919 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9920 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9921 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9922 instead.
9923
9924 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9925 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9926 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9927 rules which may be inserted.
9928
9929 Several types of actions are supported :
9930 - accept : the request is accepted
9931 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9932 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9933 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009934 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009935 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9936 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009937 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009938 - silent-drop
9939
9940 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9941 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9942 sections for a complete description.
9943
9944 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9945 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9946 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9947
9948 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9949 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9950 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9951 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9952 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9953
9954 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9955 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9956
9957 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9958 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9959 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9960
9961 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9962 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9963 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9964
9965 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9966 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9967 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9968
9969 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9970 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9971 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9972
9973 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9974
9975 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9976
9977
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009978tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9979 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9981 no | no | yes | yes
9982 Arguments :
9983 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9984 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9985 as explained at the top of this document.
9986
9987 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9988
9989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009990timeout check <timeout>
9991 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9992 established.
9993
9994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9995 yes | no | yes | yes
9996 Arguments:
9997 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9998 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9999 as explained at the top of this document.
10000
10001 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10002 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010003 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010004 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010005 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10006 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10007 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010008
10009 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10010 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10011
10012 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10013 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010014 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010015
10016 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10017 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10018 forget about it.
10019
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010020 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10021 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010022
10023
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010024timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010025 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10027 yes | yes | yes | no
10028 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010029 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010030 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10031 as explained at the top of this document.
10032
10033 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10034 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10035 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010036 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10037 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10038 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10039 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010040 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10041 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10042 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010043 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010044 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010045 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10046 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010047 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10048 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010049
10050 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10051 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10052 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10053 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010054 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010055 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10056
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010057 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010058
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010059 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010061
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010062timeout client-fin <timeout>
10063 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10065 yes | yes | yes | no
10066 Arguments :
10067 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10068 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10069 as explained at the top of this document.
10070
10071 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10072 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10073 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10074 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10075 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10076 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10077 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010078 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10079 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10080 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010081
10082 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10083 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10084 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10085
10086 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10087
10088
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010089timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010090 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10092 yes | no | yes | yes
10093 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010094 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010095 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10096 as explained at the top of this document.
10097
10098 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010099 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010100 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010101 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010102 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10103 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010104
10105 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10106 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10107 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10108 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010109 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010110 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10111
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010112 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010113
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010114
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010115timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10116 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10118 yes | yes | yes | yes
10119 Arguments :
10120 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10121 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10122 as explained at the top of this document.
10123
10124 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10125 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10126 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10127 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10128 once the request has started to present itself.
10129
10130 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10131 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10132 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10133 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10134 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10135
10136 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10137 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10138 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10139 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10140
10141 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10142 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010143 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010144 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10145 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010146 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010147
10148 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10149 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10150 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10151 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10152
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010153 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10154 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010155 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10156
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010157 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10158
10159
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010160timeout http-request <timeout>
10161 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010163 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010164 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010165 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010166 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10167 as explained at the top of this document.
10168
10169 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10170 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10171 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10172 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10173 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10174 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10175 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010176 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10177 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10178 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10179 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010180 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010181 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10182 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010183
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010184 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10185 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10186 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10187 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10188 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010189 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010190
10191 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10192 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010193 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010194 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10195 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10196
10197 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010198 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10199 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10200 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010201
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010202 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010203 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010204
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010205
10206timeout queue <timeout>
10207 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10209 yes | no | yes | yes
10210 Arguments :
10211 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10212 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10213 as explained at the top of this document.
10214
10215 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10216 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10217 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10218 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10219 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10220
10221 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10222 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10223 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10224 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10225
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010226 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010227
10228
10229timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010230 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10232 yes | no | yes | yes
10233 Arguments :
10234 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10235 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10236 as explained at the top of this document.
10237
10238 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10239 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10240 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10241 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10242 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10243 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10244 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10245
10246 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10247 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10248 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10249 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10250 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010251 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010252 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010253 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10254 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010255 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10256 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010257
10258 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10259 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10260 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10261 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010262 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010263 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10264
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010265 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010266
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010267
10268timeout server-fin <timeout>
10269 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10271 yes | no | yes | yes
10272 Arguments :
10273 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10274 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10275 as explained at the top of this document.
10276
10277 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10278 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10279 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10280 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10281 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10282 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10283 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10284 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10285 situations, it should not be needed.
10286
10287 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10288 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10289 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10290
10291 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10292
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010293
10294timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010295 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10297 yes | yes | yes | yes
10298 Arguments :
10299 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10300 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10301 as explained at the top of this document.
10302
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010303 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10304 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10305 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010306
10307 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10308 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10309 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10310 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010311 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010312
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010313 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010314
10315
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010316timeout tunnel <timeout>
10317 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10319 yes | no | yes | yes
10320 Arguments :
10321 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10322 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10323 as explained at the top of this document.
10324
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010325 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010326 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10327 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10328 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010329 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10330 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010331 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10332 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10333 specified.
10334
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010335 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10336 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10337 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10338 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10339 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10340 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10341 state.
10342
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010343 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10344 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10345 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10346 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010347 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010348
10349 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10350 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10351 forget about it.
10352
10353 Example :
10354 defaults http
10355 option http-server-close
10356 timeout connect 5s
10357 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010358 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010359 timeout server 30s
10360 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10361
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010362 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010363
10364
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010365transparent (deprecated)
10366 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010368 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010369 Arguments : none
10370
10371 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10372 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10373 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10374 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10375 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10376 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10377 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10378 appropriate server.
10379
10380 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10381
10382 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10383 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10384
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010385 See also: "option transparent"
10386
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010387unique-id-format <string>
10388 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10390 yes | yes | yes | no
10391 Arguments :
10392 <string> is a log-format string.
10393
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010394 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10395 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10396 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10397 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010398
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010399 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10400 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10401 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10402 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10403 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10404 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10405 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10406 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010407
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010408 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10409 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010410
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010411 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010412
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010413 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010414
10415 will generate:
10416
10417 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10418
10419 See also: "unique-id-header"
10420
10421unique-id-header <name>
10422 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10424 yes | yes | yes | no
10425 Arguments :
10426 <name> is the name of the header.
10427
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010428 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10429 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010430
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010431 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010432
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010433 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010434 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10435
10436 will generate:
10437
10438 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10439
10440 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010441
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010442use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010443 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10445 no | yes | yes | no
10446 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010447 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10448 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010449
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010450 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10451 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010452
10453 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10454 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10455 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010456 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010457 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010458 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10459 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010460
10461 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10462 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10463 assign the backend.
10464
10465 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10466 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10467 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10468 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10469 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10470 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10471
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010472 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010473 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010474 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10475 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10476 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10477
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010478 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10479 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10480 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10481 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10482 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10483 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10484 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10485 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10486 cannot be forced from the request.
10487
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010488 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010489 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10490 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10491
10492 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10493 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010494
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010495use-fcgi-app <name>
10496 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10498 no | no | yes | yes
10499 Arguments :
10500 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10501
10502 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010503
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010504use-server <server> if <condition>
10505use-server <server> unless <condition>
10506 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10508 no | no | yes | yes
10509 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010510 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010511
10512 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10513
10514 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10515 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10516 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10517
10518 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10519 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10520 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10521 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10522 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10523 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10524 matches will assign the server.
10525
10526 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10527 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10528 with the next rules until one matches.
10529
10530 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10531 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10532 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10533 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10534
10535 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10536 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10537 stripped.
10538
10539 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10540 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10541 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10542 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10543
10544 Example :
10545 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10546 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10547 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10548 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10549 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10550 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010551 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010552 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10553 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10554
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010555 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010556
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010557
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100105585. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010559--------------------------
10560
10561The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10562depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10563settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10564written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10565described in this section.
10566
10567
105685.1. Bind options
10569-----------------
10570
10571The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10572as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10573no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10574parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10575while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10576provided immediately after the setting name.
10577
10578The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10579
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010580accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10581 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10582 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10583 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10584 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10585 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10586 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10587 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10588 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10589 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010590 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10591 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10592 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010593
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010594accept-proxy
10595 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010596 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10597 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010598 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10599 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10600 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10601 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010602 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010603 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10604 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010605 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10606 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010607
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010608allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010609 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010610 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010611 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010612 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10613 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010614
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010615alpn <protocols>
10616 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10617 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10618 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010619 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010620 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010621 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10622 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10623 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10624 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10625 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10626 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10627 preference, like below :
10628
10629 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010630
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010631backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010632 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010633 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10634
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010635curves <curves>
10636 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10637 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10638 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10639 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10640 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10641 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10642
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010643ecdhe <named curve>
10644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010645 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10646 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010647
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010648ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10650 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10651 client's certificate.
10652
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010653ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10654 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10655 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10656 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10657 error is ignored.
10658
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010659ca-sign-file <cafile>
10660 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10661 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10662 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10663 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10664 'generate-certificates' for details.
10665
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010666ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10668 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10669 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10670 'generate-certificates' for details.
10671
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010672ciphers <ciphers>
10673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10674 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010675 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010676 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010677 information and recommendations see e.g.
10678 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10679 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10680 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10681
10682ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10684 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10685 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10686 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010687 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10688 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010689
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010690crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10692 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10693 to verify client's certificate.
10694
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010695crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010696 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10697 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10698 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10699 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10700 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10701 file.
10702
10703 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10704 are loaded.
10705
10706 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010707 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010708 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10709 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10710 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10711 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010712 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10713 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010714 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010715
10716 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10717 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10718 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10719 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010720 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10721 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010722
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010723 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010724
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010725 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010726 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010727 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10728 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010729 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10730 clients).
10731
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010732 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10733 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10734 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10735 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10736 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10737 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10738 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10739 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10740 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10741 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10742 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10743 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10744 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10745
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010746 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10747 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10748 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10749 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10750 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10751
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010752 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10753 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10754 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10755 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010756
10757 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10758 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10759 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10760 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10761 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10762 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10763 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10764 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10765 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10766
10767 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10768
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010769 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010770 a cert bundle.
10771
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010772 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010773 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10774 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10775 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10776 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10777 provide multi-cert support.
10778
10779 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10780
10781 Filename | CN | SAN
10782 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10783 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010784 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010785 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10786 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10787
10788 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10789 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10790 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10791 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010792 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10793 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10794 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010795
10796 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10797 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10798
10799 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10800 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10801 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10802
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010803crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010805 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010806 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010807 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010808
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010809crt-list <file>
10810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010811 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10812 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010813
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010814 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10815
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010816 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10817 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010818 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010819 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010820
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010821 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10822 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10823 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10824 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10825 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10826 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10827 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10828 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010829
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010830 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010831 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010832 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10833 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10834 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010835
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010836 crt-list file example:
10837 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010838 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010839 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010840 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010841
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010842defer-accept
10843 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10844 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10845 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010846 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010847 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10848 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10849 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10850 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10851 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10852 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10853 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10854
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010855expose-fd listeners
10856 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10857 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010858 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10859 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010860 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010861
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010862force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010863 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010864 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010865 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010866 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010867
10868force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010869 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010870 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010871 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010872
10873force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010874 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010875 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010876 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010877
10878force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010879 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010880 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010881 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010882
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010883force-tlsv13
10884 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10885 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010886 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010887
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010888generate-certificates
10889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10890 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10891 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10892 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10893 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10894 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10895 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10896 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10897 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10898 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10899 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10900
10901 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10902 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010903 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010904 certificate is used many times.
10905
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010906gid <gid>
10907 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10908 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10909 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10910 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10911 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10912
10913group <group>
10914 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10915 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10916 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10917 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10918 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10919
10920id <id>
10921 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10922 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10923 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10924 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10925
10926interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010927 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10928 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10929 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10930 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10931 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10932 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010933 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10934 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10935 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10936 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10937 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10938 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010939
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010940level <level>
10941 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10942 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10943 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010944 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010945 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10946 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10947 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010948 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010949 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010951 all counters).
10952
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010953severity-output <format>
10954 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10955 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10956 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10957 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10958 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10959 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10960 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10961 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10962 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10963 rfc5424 convention.
10964
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010965maxconn <maxconn>
10966 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10967 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10968 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10969 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10970 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10971 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10972 eat all memory.
10973
10974mode <mode>
10975 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10976 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10977 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10978 UNIX sockets.
10979
10980mss <maxseg>
10981 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10982 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10983 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10984 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10985 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10986 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10987 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10988 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10989 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10990 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10991 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10992
10993name <name>
10994 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10995 page.
10996
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010997namespace <name>
10998 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10999 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11000 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11001 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11002
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011003nice <nice>
11004 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11005 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11006 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11007 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11008 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11009 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11010 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11011 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11012 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11013 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11014 one for an RDP socket.
11015
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011016no-ca-names
11017 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11018 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11019
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011020no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011021 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011022 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011023 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011024 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011025 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11026 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011027
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011028no-tls-tickets
11029 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11030 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11031 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011032 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11033 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011034
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011035no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011036 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011037 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011038 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011039 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011040 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11041 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011042
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011043no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011044 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011045 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011046 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011047 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011048 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11049 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011050
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011051no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011052 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011053 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011054 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011055 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011056 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11057 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011058
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011059no-tlsv13
11060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11061 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11062 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11063 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011064 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11065 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011066
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011067npn <protocols>
11068 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11069 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11070 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011071 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011072 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011073 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11074 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11075 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11076 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11077 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011078
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011079prefer-client-ciphers
11080 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11081 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11082 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011083 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11084 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11085 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011086
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011087process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011088 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011089 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011090 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011091 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11092 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11093 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11094 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011095 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011096 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11097 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11098 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11099 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11100 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011101
11102 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11103
11104 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11105 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11106 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11107 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11108 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11109 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11110 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11111 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011112
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011113proto <name>
11114 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11115 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11116 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11117 in haproxy -vv.
11118 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11119 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011120 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011121 h2" on the bind line.
11122
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011123ssl
11124 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011125 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011126 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11127 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011128 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11129 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011130
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011131ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11132 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11133 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11134 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11135
11136ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11137 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11138 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11139 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11140
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011141strict-sni
11142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11143 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11144 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11145 See the "crt" option for more information.
11146
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011147tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011148 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011149 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11150 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011151 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011152 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11153 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11154 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11155 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11156 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11157 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11158 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11159
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011160tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011161 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011162 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11163 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11164 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11165 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11166 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11167 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11168 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011169 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11170 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11171 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011172
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011173tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11174 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011175 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11176 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11177 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11178 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11179 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11180 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11181 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11182 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11183 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11184 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011185 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11186 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11187
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011188transparent
11189 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11190 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11191 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11192 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11193 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11194 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11195 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11196 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11197 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11198 so check for support with your vendor.
11199
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011200v4v6
11201 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11202 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11203 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11204 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011205 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011206
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011207v6only
11208 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11209 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11210 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011211 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11212 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011213
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011214uid <uid>
11215 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11216 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11217 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11218 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11219 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11220
11221user <user>
11222 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11223 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11224 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11225 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11226 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11227
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011228verify [none|optional|required]
11229 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11230 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11231 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11232 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11233 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011234 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11235 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11236 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11237 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011238
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200112395.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011240------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011242The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11243which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11244arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11245settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11246after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11247Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11248address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011250 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011251 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011252
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011253Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11254keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011256The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011257
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011258addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011259 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011260 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11261 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11262 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11263 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11264 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011265
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011266agent-check
11267 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011268 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011269 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11270 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11271 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011272
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011273 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011274 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011275 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11276 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11277 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011278
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011279 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11280 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11281 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11282 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11283 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011284
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011285 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011286 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011287
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011288 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11289 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11290 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011291
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011292 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11293 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11294 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011295
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011296 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11297 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11298 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11299 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11300 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011301 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011302 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011303
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011304 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11305 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011306
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011307 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11308 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11309 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11310 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11311 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11312 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11313 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11314 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11315 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011316
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011317 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11318 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011319 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11320 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11321 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011322 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011323
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011324 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011325 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011326
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011327agent-send <string>
11328 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11329 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11330 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11331 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11332 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11333
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011334agent-inter <delay>
11335 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11336 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11337
11338 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11339 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11340 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11341 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11342 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11343 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11344 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11345 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11346 of backends use the same servers.
11347
11348 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11349
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011350agent-addr <addr>
11351 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11352
11353 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11354 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11355 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11356 hostname, it will be resolved.
11357
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011358agent-port <port>
11359 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11360
11361 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11362
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011363allow-0rtt
11364 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011365 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11366 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011367
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011368alpn <protocols>
11369 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11370 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11371 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011372 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011373 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11374 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11375 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11376 now obsolete NPN extension.
11377 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11378 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11379
11380 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011382backup
11383 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11384 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11385 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11386 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011387 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11388 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011389
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011390ca-file <cafile>
11391 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11392 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11393 server's certificate.
11394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011395check
11396 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011397 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11398 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11399 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11400 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11401 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11402 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11403 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011404 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11405 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011406 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11407 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011408
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011409check-send-proxy
11410 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11411 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11412 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11413 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11414 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11415 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11416 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11417
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011418check-alpn <protocols>
11419 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11420 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11421 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11422
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011423check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011424 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011425 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11426 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011427
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011428check-ssl
11429 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11430 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11431 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11432 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011433 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011434 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11435 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011436 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011437 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11438 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011439
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011440check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011441 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011442 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11443 for normal traffic.
11444
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011445ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11447 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11448 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011449 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11450 information and recommendations see e.g.
11451 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11452 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11453 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011454
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011455ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11457 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11458 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11459 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011460 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11461 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11462 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011464cookie <value>
11465 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11466 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11467 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11468 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11469 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11470 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11471 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11472
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011473crl-file <crlfile>
11474 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11475 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11476 to verify server's certificate.
11477
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011478crt <cert>
11479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11480 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11481 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11482 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11483 certificate request.
11484
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011485disabled
11486 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11487 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11488 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11489 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11490 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011491 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011492
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011493enabled
11494 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11495 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11496 default value.
11497 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11498 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011500error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011501 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11502 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11503 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011505 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011507fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011508 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11509 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11510 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11511
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011512force-sslv3
11513 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11514 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011515 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011516 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011517
11518force-tlsv10
11519 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011520 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011521 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011522
11523force-tlsv11
11524 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011525 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011526 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011527
11528force-tlsv12
11529 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011530 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011531 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011532
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011533force-tlsv13
11534 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11535 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011536 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011538id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011539 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11540 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11541 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011542
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011543init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11544 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11545 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011546 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011547 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11548 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11549 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11550 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11551 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11552 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11553 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11554 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11555 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011556 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011557 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11558 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11559 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11560 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11561 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11562 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011563 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011564
11565 Example:
11566 defaults
11567 # never fail on address resolution
11568 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011570inter <delay>
11571fastinter <delay>
11572downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011573 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11574 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11575 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11576 between checks depending on the server state :
11577
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011578 Server state | Interval used
11579 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11580 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11581 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11582 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11583 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11584 or yet unchecked. |
11585 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11586 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11587 | "inter" otherwise.
11588 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011590 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11591 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11592 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11593 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011594 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11595 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11596 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11597 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11598 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011600maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011601 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11602 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11603 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11604 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11605 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11606 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11607 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11608 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011610maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011611 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11612 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11613 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11614 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11615 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11616 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11617 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11618
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011619max-reuse <count>
11620 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11621 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11622 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11623 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11624 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11625 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11626 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11627 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11628
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011629minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011630 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11631 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11632 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11633 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11634 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11635 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011636 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011637 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011638
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011639namespace <name>
11640 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11641 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11642 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11643 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11644
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011645no-agent-check
11646 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11647 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11648 default value.
11649 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11650 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11651
11652no-backup
11653 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11654 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11655 default value.
11656 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11657 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11658
11659no-check
11660 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11661 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11662 default value.
11663 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11664 "default-server" "check" setting.
11665
11666no-check-ssl
11667 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11668 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11669 default value.
11670 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11671 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11672
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011673no-send-proxy
11674 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11675 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11676 default value.
11677 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11678 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11679
11680no-send-proxy-v2
11681 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11682 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11683 default value.
11684 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11685 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11686
11687no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11688 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11689 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11690 default value.
11691 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11692 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11693
11694no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11695 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11696 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11697 default value.
11698 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11699 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11700
11701no-ssl
11702 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11703 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11704 default value.
11705 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11706 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11707
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011708no-ssl-reuse
11709 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11710 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11711 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11712 and for paranoid users.
11713
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011714no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011715 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11716 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011717 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011718
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011719 Supported in default-server: No
11720
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011721no-tls-tickets
11722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11723 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11724 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011725 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11726 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011727 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011728
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011729no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011730 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011731 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11732 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011733 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11734 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011735 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011736
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011737 Supported in default-server: No
11738
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011739no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011740 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011741 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11742 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011743 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11744 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011745 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011746
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011747 Supported in default-server: No
11748
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011749no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011750 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011751 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11752 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011753 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11754 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011755 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011756
11757 Supported in default-server: No
11758
11759no-tlsv13
11760 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11761 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11762 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11763 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11764 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011765 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011766
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011767 Supported in default-server: No
11768
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011769no-verifyhost
11770 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11771 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11772 default value.
11773 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11774 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011775
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011776no-tfo
11777 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11778 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11779 default value.
11780 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11781 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11782
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011783non-stick
11784 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11785 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11786 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11787
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011788npn <protocols>
11789 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11790 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11791 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011792 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011793 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11794 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11795 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011797observe <mode>
11798 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11799 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11800 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11801 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11802 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11803 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011804 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011805
11806 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011808on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011809 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11810 Currently, four modes are available:
11811 - fastinter: force fastinter
11812 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11813 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11814 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11815 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11816
11817 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11818
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011819on-marked-down <action>
11820 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11821 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011822 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11823 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11824 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11825 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11826 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11827 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11828 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11829 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011830
11831 Actions are disabled by default
11832
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011833on-marked-up <action>
11834 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11835 Currently one action is available:
11836 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11837 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11838 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11839 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011840 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11841 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011842 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11843 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11844
11845 Actions are disabled by default
11846
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011847pool-max-conn <max>
11848 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11849 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11850 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11851 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11852 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11853 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11854
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011855pool-purge-delay <delay>
11856 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011857 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011858 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011860port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011861 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11862 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11863 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11864 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11865 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11866 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11867
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011868proto <name>
11869
11870 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11871 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11872 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11873 reported in haproxy -vv.
11874 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11875 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011877redir <prefix>
11878 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11879 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11880 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11881 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11882 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11883 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11884 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11885 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011886 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011887 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011888 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11889 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11890 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11891 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11892
11893 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011895rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011896 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11897 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11898 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11899
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011900resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11901 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11902 server.
11903
11904 Available options:
11905
11906 * allow-dup-ip
11907 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11908 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11909 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11910 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11911 For such case, simply enable this option.
11912 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11913
11914 * prevent-dup-ip
11915 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11916 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11917 same fqdn.
11918 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11919
11920 Example:
11921 backend b_myapp
11922 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11923 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11924 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11925
11926 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11927 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11928 it
11929 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11930 different address
11931
11932 Default value: not set
11933
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011934resolve-prefer <family>
11935 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11936 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11937 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11938 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11939
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011940 Default value: ipv6
11941
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011942 Example:
11943
11944 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011945
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011946resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011947 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011948 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011949 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011950 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11951 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011952 configured network, another address is selected.
11953
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011954 Example:
11955
11956 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011957
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011958resolvers <id>
11959 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11960 hostname.
11961
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011962 Example:
11963
11964 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011965
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011966 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011967
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011968send-proxy
11969 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11970 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11971 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11972 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011973 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11974 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11975 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11976 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11977 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11978 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11979 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11980 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11981 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11982 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011983 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11984 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011985
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011986send-proxy-v2
11987 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11988 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11989 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11990 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011991 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11992 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11993 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11994 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011995
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011996proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
11997 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
11998 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010011999 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12000 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012001 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12002 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012003 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012004
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012005send-proxy-v2-ssl
12006 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12007 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12008 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12009 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12010 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12011 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12012 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012013 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12014 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012015
12016send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12017 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12018 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12019 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12020 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12021 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12022 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12023 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12024 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012025 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12026 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012028slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012029 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12030 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12031 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12032 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12033 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12034 parameters :
12035
12036 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12037 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12038
12039 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12040 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12041 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12042 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12043
12044 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12045 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12046 seen as failed.
12047
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012048sni <expression>
12049 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12050 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12051 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12052 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012053 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12054 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012055 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012056 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12057 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012058
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012059source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012060source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012061source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012062 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12063 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12064 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12065 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12066
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012067 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12068 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12069 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12070 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12071 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12072 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12073 server.
12074
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012075 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12076 specifying the source address without port(s).
12077
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012078ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012079 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12080 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12081 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12082 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12083 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12084 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012085 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12086 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012087
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012088ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12089 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12090 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12091 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12092
12093ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12094 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12095 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12096 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12097
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012098ssl-reuse
12099 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12100 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12101 default value.
12102 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12103 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12104
12105stick
12106 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12107 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12108 default value.
12109 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12110 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012111
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012112socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012113 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012114 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12115 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12116
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012117tcp-ut <delay>
12118 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12119 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12120 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012121 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012122 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12123 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12124 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12125 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12126 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12127 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12128 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12129 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12130 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12131
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012132tfo
12133 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12134 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12135 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12136 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12137 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012138 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012140track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012141 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12142 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12143 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12144 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012145 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12146
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012147tls-tickets
12148 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12149 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12150 default value.
12151 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12152 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012153
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012154verify [none|required]
12155 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012156 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012157 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12158 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012159 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012160 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12161 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12162 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12163 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12164 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12165 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12166 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12167 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012168
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012169verifyhost <hostname>
12170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012171 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12172 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12173 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12174 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12175 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12176 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12177 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12178 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012179
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012180weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012181 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12182 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12183 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012184 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12185 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12186 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12187 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12188 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12189 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012190
12191
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200121925.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12193-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012194
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012195HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12196using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12197configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012198This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12199can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12200workload.
12201This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12202resolution at run time.
12203Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12204carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12205
12206
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122075.3.1. Global overview
12208----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012209
12210As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12211different steps of the process life:
12212
12213 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12214 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12215 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12216
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012217 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12218 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012219
12220A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12221 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12222 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12223 resolution to know this new IP.
12224
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012225When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012226HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012227SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12228from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12229will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12230will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012231
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012232A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012233 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012234 first valid response.
12235
12236 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12237 servers return an error.
12238
12239
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122405.3.2. The resolvers section
12241----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012242
12243This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012244HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12245contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012246
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012247When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12248uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12249is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12250answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12251
12252When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012253used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012254
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012255 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12256 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12257 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012258
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012259 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12260 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012261
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012262 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12263 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12264 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012265
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012266For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12267following scenarios are possible:
12268
12269 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12270 ignored
12271
12272 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12273 applied
12274
12275 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12276 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12277
12278 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12279 retries the query with a new type
12280
12281 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12282 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012283
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012284As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12285a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012286<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012287
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012288
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012289resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012290 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012291
12292A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12293
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012294accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012295 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012296 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012297 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12298 by RFC 6891)
12299
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012300 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12301
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012302nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12303 DNS server description:
12304 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12305 <ip> : IP address of the server
12306 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12307
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012308parse-resolv-conf
12309 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12310 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12311 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12312
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012313hold <status> <period>
12314 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12315 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012316 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012317 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012318 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12319 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12320 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12321
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012322 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012323
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012324resolve_retries <nb>
12325 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12326 giving up.
12327 Default value: 3
12328
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012329 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12330 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12331 type.
12332
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012333timeout <event> <time>
12334 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12335 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12336 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012337 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12338 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012339 Default value: 1s
12340 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012341 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012342 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012343 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12344 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12345
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012346 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012347
12348 resolvers mydns
12349 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12350 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012351 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012352 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012353 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012354 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012355 hold other 30s
12356 hold refused 30s
12357 hold nx 30s
12358 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012359 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012360 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012361
12362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123636. HTTP header manipulation
12364---------------------------
12365
12366In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12367response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12368request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12369which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012370against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012371
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012372If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12373to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12374but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12375HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12376stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12377because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12378a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12379still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012381This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12382in section 4.2 :
12383
12384 - reqadd <string>
12385 - reqallow <search>
12386 - reqiallow <search>
12387 - reqdel <search>
12388 - reqidel <search>
12389 - reqdeny <search>
12390 - reqideny <search>
12391 - reqpass <search>
12392 - reqipass <search>
12393 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12394 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12395 - reqtarpit <search>
12396 - reqitarpit <search>
12397 - rspadd <string>
12398 - rspdel <search>
12399 - rspidel <search>
12400 - rspdeny <search>
12401 - rspideny <search>
12402 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12403 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12404
12405With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12406is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12407parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12408prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12409Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12410
12411 \t for a tab
12412 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12413 \n for a new line (LF)
12414 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12415 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12416 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12417 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12418 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12419
12420The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12421portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12422above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12423regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
124249 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12425is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12426
12427The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12428after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12429
12430Notes related to these keywords :
12431---------------------------------
12432 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12433 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12434 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12435
12436 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12437 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12438 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12439
12440 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12441 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12442 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12443 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12444 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12445
12446 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12447 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12448 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12449 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12450 useless headers before adding new ones.
12451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012452 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012453 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12454
12455 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12456 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12457 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12458
12459 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12460 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012461 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012462
12463
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200124646. Cache
12465---------
12466
12467HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12468(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12469RAM.
12470
12471The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12472this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12473
12474If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12475independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12476when we try to allocate a new one.
12477
12478The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12479
12480It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12481"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12482for more details.
12483
12484When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12485replaced by "<CACHE>".
12486
12487
124886.1. Limitation
12489----------------
12490
12491The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12492
12493- If the response is not a 200
12494- If the response contains a Vary header
12495- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12496- If the response is not cacheable
12497
12498- If the request is not a GET
12499- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12500- If the request contains an Authorization header
12501
12502
125036.2. Setup
12504-----------
12505
12506To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12507the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12508
12509
125106.2.1. Cache section
12511---------------------
12512
12513cache <name>
12514 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12515 size of cache is mandatory.
12516
12517total-max-size <megabytes>
12518 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12519 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12520
12521max-object-size <bytes>
12522 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12523 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12524 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12525
12526max-age <seconds>
12527 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12528 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12529 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12530 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12531 default.
12532
12533
125346.2.2. Proxy section
12535---------------------
12536
12537http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12538 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12539 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12540 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12541 after this one.
12542
12543http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12544 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12545 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12546 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12547 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12548
12549
12550Example:
12551
12552 backend bck1
12553 mode http
12554
12555 http-request cache-use foobar
12556 http-response cache-store foobar
12557 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12558
12559 cache foobar
12560 total-max-size 4
12561 max-age 240
12562
12563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125647. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12565----------------------------------
12566
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012567HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012568client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12569The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12570these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12571but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12572data called patterns.
12573
12574
125757.1. ACL basics
12576---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012577
12578The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12579content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12580from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12581simple :
12582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012583 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012584 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012585 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12586 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012588The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12589adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012590
12591In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012593 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012594
12595This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12596Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12597and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012598an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12599conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12600as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12601are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012602
12603ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12604'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12605which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12606
12607There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12608performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012610The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12611specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12612this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012613methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12614ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012615
12616Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12617 - boolean
12618 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12619 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12620 - string
12621 - data block
12622
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012623Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12624converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12625would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12626The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12627which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12628
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012629Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12630keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12631fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12632which are summarized in the table below :
12633
12634 +---------------------+-----------------+
12635 | Sample or converter | Default |
12636 | output type | matching method |
12637 +---------------------+-----------------+
12638 | boolean | bool |
12639 +---------------------+-----------------+
12640 | integer | int |
12641 +---------------------+-----------------+
12642 | ip | ip |
12643 +---------------------+-----------------+
12644 | string | str |
12645 +---------------------+-----------------+
12646 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12647 +---------------------+-----------------+
12648
12649Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12650matching method, see below.
12651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012652The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12653 - boolean
12654 - integer or integer range
12655 - IP address / network
12656 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12657 - regular expression
12658 - hex block
12659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012660The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12661
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012662 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12663 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012664 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012665 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012666 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012667 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012668 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012670The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12671read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12672if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12673lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12674will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12675beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12676a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12677lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12678exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12679
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012680The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12681parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12682ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12683a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12684check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12685
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012686The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12687socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12688file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012690Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12691loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12692
12693 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12694
12695In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12696the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12697case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12698as well.
12699
12700The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12701sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12702do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12703methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12704is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012705obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012706followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12707default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12708that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12709string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12710
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012711The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12712By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12713string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12714resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12715server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012716waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012717flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12718function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012720There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12721sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12722be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012723
12724 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12725 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012726 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12727 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12728 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12729 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012730
12731 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12732 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012733 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012734
12735 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012736 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012737
12738 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012739 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012740
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012741 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012742 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12743
12744 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12745 binary or string samples.
12746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012747 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12748 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012750 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12751 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12752 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012754 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12755 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012757 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12758 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012760 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12761 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012763 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12764 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012765 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12768 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12769 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012770
12771For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12772request, it is possible to do :
12773
12774 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12775
12776In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12777buffer, one would use the following acl :
12778
12779 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12780
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012781On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12782possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12783
12784 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012786All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12787criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12788method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12789to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12790criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12791the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012793If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012794the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12795For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12798 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12799 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12800 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012801
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012802
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012803The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12804types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12805combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12806brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12807default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012809 +-------------------------------------------------+
12810 | Input sample type |
12811 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012812 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012813 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12814 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12815 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012816 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012817 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012818 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012819 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012820 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012822 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012823 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012824 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012825 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012826 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012827 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012828 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012829 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012830 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012831 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012832 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012834 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012835 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012836 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12838 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12839 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012840
12841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128427.1.1. Matching booleans
12843------------------------
12844
12845In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12846Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12847When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12848that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12849
12850Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12851return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12852"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12853
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128557.1.2. Matching integers
12856------------------------
12857
12858Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12859enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12860to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12861
12862Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12863matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12864lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012865
12866For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12867unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12868representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12869
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012870As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12871two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12872instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12873ranges and operators.
12874
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012875For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012876operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12877Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12878of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012880Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012881
12882 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12883 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12884 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12885 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12886 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12887
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012888For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012889
12890 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12891
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012892This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12893
12894 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12895
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128977.1.3. Matching strings
12898-----------------------
12899
12900String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12901different forms :
12902
12903 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012904 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012905
12906 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012907 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908
12909 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12910 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12911
12912 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12913 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12914
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012915 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012916 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12917 matches.
12918
12919 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12920 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12921 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012922
12923String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12924exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12925characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12926string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12927to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012928before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012929
12930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129317.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12932---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012933
12934Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12935they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12936possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12937passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12938the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012939the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12940match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012941
12942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129437.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12944-------------------------------------
12945
12946It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12947not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12948a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12949to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12950digits may be used upper or lower case.
12951
12952Example :
12953 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12954 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12955
12956
129577.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12958---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012959
12960IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12961netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12962within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012963host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012964difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12965at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12966does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12967parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012968
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012969The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12970abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12971
12972 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12973 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12974 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12975 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12976 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12977 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12978 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12979 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12980
12981Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12982192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12983
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012984IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12985Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12986trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12987IPv6 patterns.
12988
12989HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12990following situations :
12991 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12992 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12993 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12994 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12995 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12996 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12997 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12998 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12999 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13000 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013002
130037.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13004----------------------------------
13005
13006Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13007combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13008
13009 - AND (implicit)
13010 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13011 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013013A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013015 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013017Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13018indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013020For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13021"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13022requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13023is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13024
13025 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013026 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13027 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13028 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013029
13030To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13031and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13032
13033 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13034 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13035 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13036 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13037
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013038 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013039 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13040 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13041 use_backend www if host_www
13042
13043It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13044expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13045be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13046the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13047
13048 The following rule :
13049
13050 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013051 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013052
13053 Can also be written that way :
13054
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013055 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056
13057It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13058to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13059simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13060sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13061good use is the following :
13062
13063 With named ACLs :
13064
13065 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13066 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13067 monitor fail if site_dead
13068
13069 With anonymous ACLs :
13070
13071 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13072
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013073See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13074keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013075
13076
130777.3. Fetching samples
13078---------------------
13079
13080Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13081against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13082sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13083ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13084of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13085available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13086
13087This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13088Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13089compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13090deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13091
13092The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13093matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13094method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13095indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13096
13097As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13098when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13099mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13100the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13101ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13102
13103Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13104multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13105when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013106incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13107are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13109all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13110
13111Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13112 - name
13113 - name(arg1)
13114 - name(arg1,arg2)
13115
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013116
131177.3.1. Converters
13118-----------------
13119
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013120Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13121of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13122is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13123was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013124has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013125unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13126
13127These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13128sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13129the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013130support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013131
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013132A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13133support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13134supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13135(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13136bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013138The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013139
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001314051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13141 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13142 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13143 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13144 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13145 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13146
13147 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013148 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13149 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013150 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13151 frontend http-in
13152 bind *:8081
13153 default_backend servers
13154 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13155 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13156
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013157add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013158 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013159 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013160 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13161 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013162 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013163 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13164 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13165 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13166 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013167 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013168 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013169
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013170aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13171 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13172 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13173 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13174 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13175 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13176 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13177
13178 Example:
13179 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13180 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13181
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013182and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013183 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013184 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013185 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13186 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013187 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013188 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13189 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13190 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13191 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013192 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013193 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013194
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013195b64dec
13196 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13197 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13198
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013199base64
13200 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013201 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013202 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13203
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013204bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013205 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013206 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013207 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013208 presence of a flag).
13209
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013210bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13211 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13212 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013213 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013214
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013215concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13216 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13217 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13218 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13219 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13220 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13221 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13222 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13223 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13224 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13225 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013226 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013227 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013228 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013229
13230 Example:
13231 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13232 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13233 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13234 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13235
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013236cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013237 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13238 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013239
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013240crc32([<avalanche>])
13241 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13242 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13243 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13244 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13245 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13246 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13247 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13248 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13249 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13250 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013251 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13252
13253crc32c([<avalanche>])
13254 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13255 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13256 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13257 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13258 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13259 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13260 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13261 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013262
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013263da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013264 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13265 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13266 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13267 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013268 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013269 configuration language.
13270
13271 Example:
13272 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013273 bind *:8881
13274 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013275 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013276
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013277debug
13278 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13279 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13280 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13281
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013282div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013283 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13284 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013285 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013286 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13287 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013288 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013289 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13290 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13291 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13292 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013293 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013294 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013295
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013296djb2([<avalanche>])
13297 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13298 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13299 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13300 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13301 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13302 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13303 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013304 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13305 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013306
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013307even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013308 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013309 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13310
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013311field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13312 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13313 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13314 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13315 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13316 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13317 fields.
13318
13319 Example :
13320 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13321 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13322 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13323 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13324 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013325
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013326hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013327 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013328 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013329 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013330 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013331
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013332hex2i
13333 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013334 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013335
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013336http_date([<offset>])
13337 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13338 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13339 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13340 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13341 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13342 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013343
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013344in_table(<table>)
13345 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13346 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13347 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013348 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013349 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13350
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013351ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13352 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013353 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013354 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13355 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13356 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13357 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13358 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013359
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013360json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013361 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013362 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013363 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013364 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13365 of errors:
13366 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13367 bytes, ...)
13368 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13369 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13370
13371 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13372 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13373 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13374 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13375 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13376 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013377 - "ascii" : never fails;
13378 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13379 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013380 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013381 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013382 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13383 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13384
13385 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013386 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013387
13388 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013389 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013390 capture request header user-agent len 150
13391 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013392
13393 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13394 GET / HTTP/1.0
13395 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13396
13397 Output log:
13398 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13399
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013400language(<value>[,<default>])
13401 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13402 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13403 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13404 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13405 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13406 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13407 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13408 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13409 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013410 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013411 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13412 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013413
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013414 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013416 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13417 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013418
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013419 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13420 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13421 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13422 use_backend spanish if es
13423 use_backend french if fr
13424 use_backend english if en
13425 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013426
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013427length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013428 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13429 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13430 type. The result is of type integer.
13431
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013432lower
13433 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13434 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13435 type. The result is of type string.
13436
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013437ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13438 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13439 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13440 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13441 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13442 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13443 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13444
13445 Example :
13446
13447 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013448 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013449 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013451map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13452map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13453map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13454 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13455 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13456 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13457 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13458 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13459 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13460 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13461 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013462
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013463 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13464 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13465 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013466
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013467 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013468 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013469
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013470 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13471 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13472 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13473 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013474 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13475 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013476 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13477 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13478 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13479 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13480 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13481 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13482 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13483 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013484 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13485 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13486 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013487 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13488 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13489 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13490 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13491 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013492
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013493 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13494 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13495 the corresponding match text.
13496
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013497 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13498 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13499 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13500 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13501 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013502
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013503 Example :
13504
13505 # this is a comment and is ignored
13506 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13507 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13508 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13509 | | | `---------- value
13510 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13511 | `---------------------------- key
13512 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13513
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013514mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013515 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13516 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013517 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013518 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013519 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013520 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13521 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13522 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13523 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013524 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013525 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013526
13527mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013528 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013529 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13530 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013531 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013532 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013533 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013534 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13535 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13536 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13537 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013538 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013539 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013540
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013541nbsrv
13542 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13543 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13544 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13545 map lookup.
13546
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013547neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013548 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13549 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13550 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13551 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013552
13553not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013554 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013555 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013556 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013557 absence of a flag).
13558
13559odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013560 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013561 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13562
13563or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013564 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013565 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013566 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13567 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013568 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013569 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13570 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13571 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13572 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013573 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013574 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013575
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013576protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13577 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13578 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13579 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13580 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13581 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13582 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13583 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13584 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13585 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13586 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13587 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13588
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013589regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013590 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13591 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13592 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13593 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13594 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13595 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13596 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13597 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13598 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13599 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013600 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13601 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13602 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13603 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013604
13605 Example :
13606
13607 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13608 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13609 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13610 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13611
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013612capture-req(<id>)
13613 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13614 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13615
13616 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013617 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13618 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013619
13620capture-res(<id>)
13621 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13622 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13623
13624 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013625 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13626 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013627
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013628sdbm([<avalanche>])
13629 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13630 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13631 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13632 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13633 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13634 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13635 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013636 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13637 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013638
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013639set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013640 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13641 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13642 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013643 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013644 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13645 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013646 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013647 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13648 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013649 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013650 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013651
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013652sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013653 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013654 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13655
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013656sha2([<bits>])
13657 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13658 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13659
13660 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13661 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13662
13663 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13664 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13665
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013666srv_queue
13667 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13668 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13669 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13670 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13671 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13672
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013673strcmp(<var>)
13674 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13675 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13676 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13677 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13678 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13679 shorter).
13680
13681 Example :
13682
13683 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13684 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13685 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13686
13687
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013688sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013689 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13690 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013691 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013692 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13693 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013694 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013695 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13696 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013697 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013698 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13699 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013700 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013701 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013702
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013703table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13704 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13705 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13706 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13707 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13708 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13709 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13710
13711
13712table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13713 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13714 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13715 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13716 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13717 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13718 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13719
13720table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13721 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13722 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013723 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013724 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13725 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13726
13727table_conn_cur(<table>)
13728 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13729 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13730 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13731 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13732 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13733
13734table_conn_rate(<table>)
13735 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13736 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13737 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13738 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13739 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13740
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013741table_gpt0(<table>)
13742 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13743 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13744 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13745 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13746 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13747
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013748table_gpc0(<table>)
13749 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13750 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13751 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13752 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13753 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13754
13755table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13756 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13757 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13758 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13759 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13760 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13761 sample fetch keyword.
13762
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013763table_gpc1(<table>)
13764 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13765 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13766 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13767 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13768 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13769
13770table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13771 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13772 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13773 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13774 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13775 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13776 sample fetch keyword.
13777
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013778table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13779 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13780 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013781 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013782 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13783 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13784
13785table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13786 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13787 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13788 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13789 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13790 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13791 keyword.
13792
13793table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13794 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13795 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013796 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013797 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13798 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13799
13800table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13801 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13802 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13803 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13804 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13805 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13806 keyword.
13807
13808table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13809 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13810 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013811 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013812 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13813 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13814 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13815 keyword.
13816
13817table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13818 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13819 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013820 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013821 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13822 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13823 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13824 keyword.
13825
13826table_server_id(<table>)
13827 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13828 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13829 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13830 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13831 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13832 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13833
13834table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13835 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13836 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013837 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013838 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13839 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13840 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13841 keyword.
13842
13843table_sess_rate(<table>)
13844 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13845 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13846 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13847 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13848 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13849 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13850 keyword.
13851
13852table_trackers(<table>)
13853 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13854 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13855 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13856 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13857 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13858 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13859 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13860 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13861 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13862 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13863
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013864upper
13865 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13866 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13867 type. The result is of type string.
13868
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013869url_dec
13870 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13871 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13872
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013873ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013874 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013875 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13876 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13877 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013878 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13879 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13880 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13881 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013882 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013883 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13884 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013885
13886 Example:
13887 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13888 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13889
13890 message Point {
13891 int32 latitude = 1;
13892 int32 longitude = 2;
13893 }
13894
13895 message PPoint {
13896 Point point = 59;
13897 }
13898
13899 message Rectangle {
13900 // One corner of the rectangle.
13901 PPoint lo = 48;
13902 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13903 PPoint hi = 49;
13904 }
13905
13906 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13907 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13908 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13909
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013910 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13911 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013912 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013913 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13914
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013915 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013916
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013917 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013918
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013919 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013920 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13921 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13922
13923 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13924 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13925 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13926
13927 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13928 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13929 interpret the previous binary sample.
13930
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013931
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013932unset-var(<var name>)
13933 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13934 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13935 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13936 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13937 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13938 response),
13939 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13940 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13941 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13942 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13943
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013944utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13945 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13946 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13947 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13948 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13949 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13950 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13951
13952 Example :
13953
13954 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013955 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013956 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13957
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013958word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13959 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13960 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13961 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13962 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13963 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13964
13965 Example :
13966 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13967 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13968 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13969 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13970 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013971
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013972wt6([<avalanche>])
13973 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13974 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13975 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13976 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13977 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13978 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13979 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013980 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13981 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013982
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013983xor(<value>)
13984 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013985 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013986 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013987 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013988 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013989 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13990 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013991 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013992 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13993 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013994 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013995 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013996
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013997xxh32([<seed>])
13998 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13999 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14000 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14001 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14002 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14003 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14004 as cryptographically secure.
14005
14006xxh64([<seed>])
14007 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14008 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14009 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14010 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14011 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14012 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14013 as cryptographically secure.
14014
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014015
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140167.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014017--------------------------------------------
14018
14019A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14020not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14021"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14022The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14023
14024always_false : boolean
14025 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14026 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14027
14028always_true : boolean
14029 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14030 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14031
14032avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014033 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14035 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14036 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14037 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14038 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14039 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14040 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14041 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14042 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14043 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14044 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14045 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14046 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014048be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014049 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14050 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14051 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14052 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014053 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14054
14055be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14056 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14057 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14058 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14059 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14060 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014061 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14062 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014063
14064 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14065 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14066 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014068be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14069 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14070 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14071 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014072 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014073 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14074 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014075
14076 Example :
14077 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14078 backend dynamic
14079 mode http
14080 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14081 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014082
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014083bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014084 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14085 of the string.
14086
14087bool(<bool>) : bool
14088 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14089 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014091connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14092 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014093 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014094 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14095 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014096
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014097 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014098 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014099 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14100
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014101 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14102 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014103
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014104 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014105 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014106 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014107 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014108 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014110 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014111
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014112 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14113 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014114 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014115 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014116
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014117cpu_calls : integer
14118 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14119 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14120 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14121 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14122 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14123 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14124
14125cpu_ns_avg : integer
14126 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14127 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14128 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14129 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14130 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14131 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14132 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14133 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14134 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14135 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14136 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14137
14138cpu_ns_tot : integer
14139 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14140 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14141 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14142 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14143 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14144 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14145 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14146 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14147 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14148 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14149 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14150 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14151 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14152
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014153date([<offset>]) : integer
14154 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14155 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14156 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14157 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014158 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14159
14160 Example :
14161
14162 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14163 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014164
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014165date_us : integer
14166 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14167 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14168 from the same timeval structure.
14169
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014170distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14171 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14172 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14173 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14174 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14175 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14176 list of supported tokens.
14177
14178distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14179 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14180 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14181 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14182 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14183 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14184 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14185 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14186 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14187 supported tokens.
14188
14189 Example :
14190 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14191 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14192 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14193 # send large files to the big farm
14194 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14195
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014196env(<name>) : string
14197 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14198 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14199 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14200 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14201 certain way.
14202
14203 Examples :
14204 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14205 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14206
14207 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14208 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14211 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014212 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14213 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14215 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014216 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014217 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14218 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014219
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014220fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14221 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14222 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14223 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014225fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14226 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14227 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14228 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14229 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14230 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14231 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14232 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14233 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014234
14235 Example :
14236 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14237 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14238 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14239 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14240 frontend mail
14241 bind :25
14242 mode tcp
14243 maxconn 100
14244 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14245 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14246 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14247 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014248
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014249hostname : string
14250 Returns the system hostname.
14251
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014252int(<integer>) : signed integer
14253 Returns a signed integer.
14254
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014255ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14256 Returns an ipv4.
14257
14258ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14259 Returns an ipv6.
14260
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014261lat_ns_avg : integer
14262 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14263 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14264 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14265 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14266 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14267 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14268 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14269 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14270 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14271 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14272 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14273 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14274 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14275 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14276
14277lat_ns_tot : integer
14278 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14279 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14280 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14281 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14282 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14283 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14284 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14285 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14286 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14287 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14288 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14289 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14290 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14291 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14292 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14293 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14294 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14295 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14296 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14297
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014298meth(<method>) : method
14299 Returns a method.
14300
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014301nbproc : integer
14302 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14303 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14304 and debugging purposes.
14305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14307 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14308 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14309 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014310 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14311 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14312 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014313
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014314prio_class : integer
14315 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14316 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14317 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14318
14319prio_offset : integer
14320 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14321 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14322 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14323 set-priority-offset".
14324
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014325proc : integer
14326 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14327 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14328 debugging purposes.
14329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014330queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014331 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14332 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14333 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014334 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14335 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14336 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14337 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14338 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14339
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014340rand([<range>]) : integer
14341 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14342 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14343 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14344 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14345 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14346
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014347uuid([<version>]) : string
14348 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14349 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14350 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014352srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14353 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14354 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14355 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14356 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14357 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014358 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14359 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14360
14361srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14362 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14363 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14364 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14365 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14366 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14367 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14368 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14369
14370 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14371 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014372
14373srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14374 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14375 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14376 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014377 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014378 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14379 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14380 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14381
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014382srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14383 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14384 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14385 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14386 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14387 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14388 fetch methods.
14389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014390srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14391 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14392 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014393 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14395 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014396 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014397 overloading servers).
14398
14399 Example :
14400 # Redirect to a separate back
14401 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14402 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14403 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14404
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014405stopping : boolean
14406 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14407 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14408 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14409
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014410str(<string>) : string
14411 Returns a string.
14412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014413table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14414 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14415 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14416
14417table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14418 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14419 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14420 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14421
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014422thread : integer
14423 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14424 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14425 and debugging purposes.
14426
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014427var(<var-name>) : undefined
14428 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014429 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14430 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014431 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014432 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14433 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014434 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014435 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14436 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014437 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014438 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014439
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144407.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014441----------------------------------
14442
14443The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14444closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14445methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14446sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14447TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014448the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14449counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014450"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14451used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14452can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14453Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14454table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14455tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14456currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014457
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014458bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014459 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14460 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14461 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014463be_id : integer
14464 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14465 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14466
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014467be_name : string
14468 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14469 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014471dst : ip
14472 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14473 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14474 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14475 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014476 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14477 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14478 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14479 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14480 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14481 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014482
14483dst_conn : integer
14484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14485 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14486 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14487 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14488 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14489 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14490 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14491 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014492
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014493dst_is_local : boolean
14494 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14495 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14496 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14497 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014498 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014499 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14500 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14501 it only once per connection.
14502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014503dst_port : integer
14504 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14505 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14506 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14507 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14508 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14509 an HTTP header.
14510
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014511fc_http_major : integer
14512 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14513 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14514 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14515
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014516fc_pp_authority : string
14517 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14518 if any.
14519
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014520fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14521 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14522 header.
14523
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014524fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14525 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14526 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14527 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14528 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14529 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14530 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14531
14532fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14533 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14534 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14535 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14536 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14537 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14538 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14539
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014540fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14541 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14542 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14543 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14544 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14545
14546fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14547 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14548 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14549 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14550 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14551
14552fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14553 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14554 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14555 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14556 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14557
14558fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14559 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14560 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14561 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14562 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14563
14564fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14565 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14566 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14567 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14568 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14569
14570fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14571 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14572 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14573 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14574 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14575
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014576fe_defbe : string
14577 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14578 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014580fe_id : integer
14581 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014582 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014583 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14584
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014585fe_name : string
14586 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14587 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14588 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14589
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014590sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014591sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14592sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14593sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014594 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14595 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14596 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14597
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014598sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014599sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14600sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14601sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014602 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14603 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14604 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14605
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014606sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014607sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14608sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14609sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014610 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14611 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014612 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14613 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14614 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014615
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014616 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014617 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14618 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014619 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14620 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14621 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014622 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14623 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14624
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014625sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14626sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14627sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14628sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14629 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14630 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14631 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14632 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14633 when a first ACL was verified.
14634
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014635sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014636sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14637sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14638sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014639 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014640 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14641
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014642sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014643sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14644sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14645sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014646 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14647 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14648 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14649
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014650sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014651sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14652sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14653sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014654 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14655 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14656 See also src_conn_rate.
14657
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014658sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014659sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14660sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14661sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014662 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014663 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014664
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014665sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14666sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14667sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14668sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14669 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14670 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14671
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014672sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14673sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14674sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14675sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14676 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14677 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14678
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014679sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014680sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14681sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14682sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014683 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14684 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14685 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014686 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14687 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14688 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014689
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014690sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14691sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14692sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14693sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14694 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14695 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14696 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14697 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14698 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14699 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14700
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014701sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014702sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14703sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14704sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014705 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014706 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14707 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014709sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014710sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14711sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14712sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014713 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14714 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14715 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14716 src_http_err_rate.
14717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014718sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014719sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14720sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14721sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014722 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014723 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14724 src_http_req_cnt.
14725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014726sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014727sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14728sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14729sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014730 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14731 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14732 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14733 src_http_req_rate.
14734
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014735sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014736sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14737sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14738sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014739 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014740 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14741 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14742 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14743 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014744
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014745 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014746 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14747 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014748 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14749
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014750sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14751sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14752sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14753sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14754 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14755 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14756 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14757 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14758 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14759
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014760sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014761sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14762sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14763sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014764 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14765 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14766 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014767
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014768sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014769sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14770sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14771sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014772 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14773 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14774 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014775
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014776sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014777sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14778sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14779sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014780 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014781 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14782 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14783 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014784 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014785 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14786
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014787sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014788sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14789sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14790sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014791 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14792 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14793 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14794 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14795 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014796 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014797
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014798sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014799sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14800sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14801sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014802 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14803 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14804 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14805
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014806sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014807sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14808sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14809sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014810 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14811 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014812 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014813 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14814 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14816 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14817 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819so_id : integer
14820 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14821 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14822 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014825 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14827 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14828 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014829 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14830 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14831 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014832 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14833 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14834 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14835 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14836 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14837 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14838 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014839
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014840 Example:
14841 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14842 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14845 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14846 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14847 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014848 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014850src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14851 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14852 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014853 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014854 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14857 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14858 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14859 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14860 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14861 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14862 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014863
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014864 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014865 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14866 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14867 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14868 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014869 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014870 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14871 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14872
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014873src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14874 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14875 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14876 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14877 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14878 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14879 was verified.
14880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014881src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014882 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014884 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014885 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014887src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014888 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014889 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14890 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014891 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14894 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14895 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14896 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014897 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014899src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014900 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014901 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014902 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014903 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014904
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014905src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14906 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14907 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14908 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14909 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14910
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014911src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14912 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14913 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14914 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14915 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014917src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014918 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014920 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14921 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014922 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14923 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14924 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014925
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014926src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14927 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14928 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14929 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14930 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14931 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14932 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14933 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014935src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014936 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014937 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014938 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014939 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014940 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014942src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14943 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14944 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14945 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14946 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014947 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014949src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014950 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014951 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14952 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014953 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14956 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14957 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14958 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014959 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014960 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014962src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14963 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14964 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14965 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014966 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14968 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014969
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014970 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014971 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014972 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014973 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014974
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014975src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14976 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14977 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14978 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14979 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14980 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14981 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14982
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014983src_is_local : boolean
14984 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14985 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14986 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14987 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014988 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014989 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14990 once per connection.
14991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014992src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014993 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14994 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14995 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14996 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14997 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014999src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015000 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15001 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15002 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15003 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15004 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015006src_port : integer
15007 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15008 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15009 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15010 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015012src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015013 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015014 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15015 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15016 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015017 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015019src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15020 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15021 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15022 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15023 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015024 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15027 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15028 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15029 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15030 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15031 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15032 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15033 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15034 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015035
15036 Example :
15037 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15038 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15039 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15040 listen ssh
15041 bind :22
15042 mode tcp
15043 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015044 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015045 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015046 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015048srv_id : integer
15049 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15050 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15051 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015052
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150537.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015054----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015056The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15057closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15058when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15059usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015060future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015061
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001506251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15063 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15064 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15065 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15066 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15067 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15068
15069 Example :
15070 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15071 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15072 # the request.
15073 frontend http-in
15074 bind *:8081
15075 default_backend servers
15076 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15077 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15078
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015079ssl_bc : boolean
15080 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15081 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15082 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15083
15084ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15085 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15086 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15087
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015088ssl_bc_alpn : string
15089 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15090 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015091 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015092 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15093 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15094 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15095 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15096 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15097 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15098
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015099ssl_bc_cipher : string
15100 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15101 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15102
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015103ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15104 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15105 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15106 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15107
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015108ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15109 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15110 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15111 session or a TLS ticket.
15112
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015113ssl_bc_npn : string
15114 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15115 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015116 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015117 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15118 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15119 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15120 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15121 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15122
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015123ssl_bc_protocol : string
15124 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15125 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15126
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015127ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015128 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015129 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15130 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015131
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015132ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15133 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15134 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15135 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15136
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015137ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15138 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15139 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15140 if session was reused or not.
15141
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015142ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15143 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15144 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15145 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15146 BoringSSL.
15147
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015148ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15149 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15150 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15153 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15154 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15155 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15156 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15157 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015159ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15160 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15161 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15162 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15163 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015164
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015165ssl_c_der : binary
15166 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15167 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15168 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170ssl_c_err : integer
15171 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15172 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15173 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15174 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15175 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15178 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15179 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15180 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15181 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15182 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15183 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15184 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15185 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187ssl_c_key_alg : string
15188 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15189 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15190 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015192ssl_c_notafter : string
15193 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15194 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15195 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197ssl_c_notbefore : string
15198 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15199 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15200 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15203 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15204 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15205 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15206 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15207 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15208 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15209 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15210 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015212ssl_c_serial : binary
15213 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15214 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15215 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15218 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15219 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15220 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015221 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15222 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15223
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015224 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015225 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015227ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15228 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15229 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15230 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232ssl_c_used : boolean
15233 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15234 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236ssl_c_verify : integer
15237 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15238 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15239 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15240 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015242ssl_c_version : integer
15243 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15244 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015245
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015246ssl_f_der : binary
15247 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15248 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15249 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15252 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15253 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15254 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15255 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015256 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015257 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15258 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15259 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015261ssl_f_key_alg : string
15262 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15263 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15264 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266ssl_f_notafter : string
15267 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15268 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15269 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015271ssl_f_notbefore : string
15272 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15273 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15274 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15277 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15278 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15279 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15280 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15281 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15282 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15283 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15284 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015286ssl_f_serial : binary
15287 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15288 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15289 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015290
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015291ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15292 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15293 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15294 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015296ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15297 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15298 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15299 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015301ssl_f_version : integer
15302 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15303 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15304
15305ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015306 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15307 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15308 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310 Example :
15311 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15312 listen http-https
15313 bind :80
15314 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15315 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15316
15317ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15318 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15319 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15320
15321ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015322 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15324 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15325 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15326 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15327 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15328 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15329 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15330 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332ssl_fc_cipher : string
15333 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15334 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015335
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015336ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15337 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15338 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015339 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015340
15341ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15342 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15343 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015344 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015345
15346ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15347 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15348 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15349 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015350 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015351 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015352
15353ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15354 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15355 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015356 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015357
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015358ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15359 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15360 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15361 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015363ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015364 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15365 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015366 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15367 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15368 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15369 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015370
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015371ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15372 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15373 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15374 wait until the handshake happened.
15375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015376ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15377 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015378 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15379 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015380 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015381 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015382
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015383ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015384 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015385 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15386 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015389 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015390 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15391 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15392 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15393 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15394 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15395 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15396 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015398ssl_fc_protocol : string
15399 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15400 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015401
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015402ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015403 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015404 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15405 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015406
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015407ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15408 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15409 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15410 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15413 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15414 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15415 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15416 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015417
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015418ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15419 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15420 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15421 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15422 BoringSSL.
15423
15424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425ssl_fc_sni : string
15426 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15427 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15428 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15429 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15430 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15431
15432 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15433 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15434 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015435 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015436 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015438 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15440 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15443 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15444 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015445
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015446
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154477.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015450Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15451sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15452only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15453For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15454be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15455can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15456sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15457for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15458content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015461 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15463 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015465payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15466 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015467 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015468 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015469
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015470req.hdrs : string
15471 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15472 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15473 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15474 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15475
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015476req.hdrs_bin : binary
15477 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15478 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15479 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15480 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15481 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15482 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15483
15484 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15485
15486 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15487 str: <int:length><bytes>
15488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489req.len : integer
15490req_len : integer (deprecated)
15491 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15492 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15493 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15494 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15495 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15496 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15497 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15498 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015500req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15501 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015502 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15503 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15504 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15505 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507 ACL alternatives :
15508 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015510req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15511 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15512 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15513 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15514 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516 ACL alternatives :
15517 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521req.proto_http : boolean
15522req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15523 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15524 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15525 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15526 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15527 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15528 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15529 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531 Example:
15532 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15533 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15534 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015535 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15538rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15539 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15540 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15541 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15542 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15543 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15544 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15545 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15548 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15549 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15550 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15551 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15552 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554 ACL derivatives :
15555 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557 Example :
15558 listen tse-farm
15559 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15560 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15561 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15562 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15563 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15564 persist rdp-cookie
15565 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15566 # This is only useful makes sense if
15567 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15568 stick-table type string size 204800
15569 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15570 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15571 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15574 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15577rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15578 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15579 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15580 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15581 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583 ACL derivatives :
15584 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015585
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015586req.ssl_alpn : string
15587 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15588 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15589 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15590 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15591 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15592 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015593 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015594
15595 Examples :
15596 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15597 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15598 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015599 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015600 default_backend bk_default
15601
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015602req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15603 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15604 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015605 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15606 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15607 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15608 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15609 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015611req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15612req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15613 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15614 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15615 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15616 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15617 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15618 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15619 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621req.ssl_sni : string
15622req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15623 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15624 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15625 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15626 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15627 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15628 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15629 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15630 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15631 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15632 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15633 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15634 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636 ACL derivatives :
15637 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639 Examples :
15640 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15641 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15642 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15643 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15644 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015645
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015646req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15647 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15648 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15649 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15650 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15651 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15652 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15653 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15654 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15655 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657req.ssl_ver : integer
15658req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15659 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15660 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15661 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15662 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15663 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15664 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15665 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015666 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669 ACL derivatives :
15670 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015671
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015672res.len : integer
15673 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15674 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15675 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15676 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15677 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15678 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15679 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15680 content inspection.
15681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15683 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015684 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15685 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15686 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15687 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15690 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15691 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15692 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15693 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015696
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015697res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15698rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15699 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15700 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15701 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15702 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15703 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15704 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15705 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707wait_end : boolean
15708 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15709 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015710 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15712 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015713 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15715 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 Examples :
15718 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15719 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15720 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15723 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15724 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15725 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15726 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15727 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15728 tcp-request content reject
15729
15730
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157317.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732--------------------------------------
15733
15734It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15735This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15736data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15737its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15738HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15739content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15740to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15741more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15742response are indexed.
15743
15744base : string
15745 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15746 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15747 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15748 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15749 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15750 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15751 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15752 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15753
15754 ACL derivatives :
15755 base : exact string match
15756 base_beg : prefix match
15757 base_dir : subdir match
15758 base_dom : domain match
15759 base_end : suffix match
15760 base_len : length match
15761 base_reg : regex match
15762 base_sub : substring match
15763
15764base32 : integer
15765 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15766 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15767 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015768 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15769 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15770 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771
15772base32+src : binary
15773 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15774 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15775 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15776 per-URL counters.
15777
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015778capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15779 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15780 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15781 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15782
15783capture.req.method : string
15784 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15785 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15786 because it's allocated.
15787
15788capture.req.uri : string
15789 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15790 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15791 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15792 allocated.
15793
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015794capture.req.ver : string
15795 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15796 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15797 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15798
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015799capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15800 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15801 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15802 The first entry is an index of 0.
15803 See also: "capture response header"
15804
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015805capture.res.ver : string
15806 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15807 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15808 persistent flag.
15809
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015810req.body : binary
15811 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15812 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15813 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15814 the first chunk is analyzed.
15815
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015816req.body_param([<name>) : string
15817 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15818 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15819 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15820 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15821 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15822 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15823 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15824 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15825 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15826 given.
15827
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015828req.body_len : integer
15829 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15830 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15831 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15832 "option http-buffer-request".
15833
15834req.body_size : integer
15835 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15836 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15837 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15838 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15839 "option http-buffer-request".
15840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015841req.cook([<name>]) : string
15842cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15843 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15844 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15845 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15846 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15847 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15848 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15849 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15850 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15851
15852 ACL derivatives :
15853 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15854 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15855 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15856 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15857 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15858 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15859 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15860 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15863cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15864 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15865 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15868cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15869 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15870 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15871 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15872 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15875 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15876 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15877 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15878 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015879 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15881 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15882 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15883 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015885hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15886 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15887 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15888 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15889 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015890 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15893 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15894 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15895 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15896 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15897 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15898 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15899 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15900 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15903 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15904 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15905 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15906 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15909 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15910 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15911 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15912 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15913 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15914 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15915 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15916 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015917 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015919 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921 ACL derivatives :
15922 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15923 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15924 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15925 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15926 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15927 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15928 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15929 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15930
15931req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15932hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15933 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15934 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15935 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15936 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15937 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15938 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15939 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15940 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15941 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15942
15943req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15944hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15945 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15946 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15947 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15948 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15949 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015950 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015951 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15952 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15953
15954req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15955hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15956 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15957 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15958 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15959 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15960 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15961 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15962 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15963
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015964
15965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15967 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15968 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15969 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15970 basic auth is supported.
15971
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015972http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15973 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15974 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15975 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15976 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15978 basic auth is supported.
15979
15980 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015981 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15982 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15983 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15984 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020015986http_auth_pass : string
15987 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
15988 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15989 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15990
15991http_auth_type : string
15992 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
15993 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15994 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15995
15996http_auth_user : string
15997 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
15998 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
15999 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016001http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016002 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16003 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016004 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16005 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007method : integer + string
16008 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16009 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16010 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16011 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16012 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16013 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16014 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016 ACL derivatives :
16017 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016019 Example :
16020 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16021 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16022 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016024path : string
16025 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16026 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16027 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16028 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16029 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016030 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016033 ACL derivatives :
16034 path : exact string match
16035 path_beg : prefix match
16036 path_dir : subdir match
16037 path_dom : domain match
16038 path_end : suffix match
16039 path_len : length match
16040 path_reg : regex match
16041 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016042
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016043query : string
16044 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16045 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16046 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16047 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016048 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016049 which stops before the question mark.
16050
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016051req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16052 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16053 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16054 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16055 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057req.ver : string
16058req_ver : string (deprecated)
16059 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16060 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16061 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063 ACL derivatives :
16064 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066res.comp : boolean
16067 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16068 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16069 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071res.comp_algo : string
16072 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16073 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16074 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076res.cook([<name>]) : string
16077scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16078 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16079 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16080 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082 ACL derivatives :
16083 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16086scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16087 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16088 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16089 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016091res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16092scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16093 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16094 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16095 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16098 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16099 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16100 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16101 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16102 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16103 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16104 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16105 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16106 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016108res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16109 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16110 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16111 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16112 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16113 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16116shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16117 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16118 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16119 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16120 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16121 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16122 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16123 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16124 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126 ACL derivatives :
16127 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16128 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16129 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16130 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16131 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16132 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16133 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16134 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16135
16136res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16137shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16138 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16139 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16140 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16141 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16142 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016144res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16145shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16146 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16147 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16148 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16149 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16150 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16151 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016152
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016153res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16154 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16155 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16156 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16157 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16160shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16161 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16162 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16163 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16164 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16165 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16166 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168res.ver : string
16169resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16170 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16171 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016173 ACL derivatives :
16174 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016176set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16177 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16178 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016179 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016180 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016182 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16183 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016185status : integer
16186 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16187 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16188 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016189
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016190unique-id : string
16191 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16192 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16193 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16194 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16195 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16196 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198url : string
16199 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16200 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16201 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16202 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16203 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16204 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16205 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016207 ACL derivatives :
16208 url : exact string match
16209 url_beg : prefix match
16210 url_dir : subdir match
16211 url_dom : domain match
16212 url_end : suffix match
16213 url_len : length match
16214 url_reg : regex match
16215 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016217url_ip : ip
16218 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16219 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16220 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16221 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16222 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16223 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16224 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016226url_port : integer
16227 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16228 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16229 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16230 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016231
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016232urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16233url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016234 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16235 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016236 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16237 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16238 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16239 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16241 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016242 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16243 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245 ACL derivatives :
16246 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16247 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16248 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16249 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16250 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16251 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16252 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16253 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016254
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016256 Example :
16257 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16258 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16259 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16260 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016261
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016262urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16264 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16265 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016266
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016267url32 : integer
16268 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16269 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16270 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16271 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16272 is an unsigned integer.
16273
16274url32+src : binary
16275 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16276 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16277 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16278
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162807.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016281---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016283Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16284every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016285order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016287ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16288---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016289FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016290HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016291HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16292HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016293HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16294HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16295HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16296HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16297LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016298METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016299METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016300METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16301METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16302METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16303METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016304METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016305METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016306RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016307REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016308TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016309WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16310---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016311
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163138. Logging
16314----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016315
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016316One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16317provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16318very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16319provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16320state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016321to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016322headers.
16323
16324In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16325about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16326send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16327
16328 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16329 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16330 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16331 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16332 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016333 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016334 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016335
16336The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16337allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16338as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16339while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16340real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16341delay.
16342
16343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163448.1. Log levels
16345---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016346
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016347TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016348source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016349HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16350in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16351track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16352syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16353about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016354
16355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163568.2. Log formats
16357----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016358
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016359HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016360and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16361slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16362options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016363
16364 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16365 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16366 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16367 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16368 extents.
16369
16370 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16371 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16372 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16373 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16374 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16375
16376 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16377 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16378 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16379 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16380 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16381
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016382 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16383 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16384 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16385 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16386
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016387 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16388
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016389Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16390specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16391field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16392servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16393always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16394identifier.
16395
16396Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16397 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16398 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16399 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16400 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16401
16402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164038.2.1. Default log format
16404-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016405
16406This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16407as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16408format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16409
16410 Example :
16411 listen www
16412 mode http
16413 log global
16414 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16415
16416 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16417 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16418 (www/HTTP)
16419
16420 Field Format Extract from the example above
16421 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16422 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16423 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16424 4 'to' to
16425 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16426 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16427
16428Detailed fields description :
16429 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16430 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16431 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16432 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16433 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16434 and processed the connection.
16435 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16436
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016437In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16438"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16439connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16440
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016441It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16442will eventually disappear.
16443
16444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164458.2.2. TCP log format
16446---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016447
16448The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16449is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16450information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16451counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16452emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16453environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16454the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16455sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016456specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16457not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16458fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16459marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016460
16461 Example :
16462 frontend fnt
16463 mode tcp
16464 option tcplog
16465 log global
16466 default_backend bck
16467
16468 backend bck
16469 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16470
16471 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16472 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16473 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16474
16475 Field Format Extract from the example above
16476 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16477 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16478 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16479 4 frontend_name fnt
16480 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16481 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16482 7 bytes_read* 212
16483 8 termination_state --
16484 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16485 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16486
16487Detailed fields description :
16488 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016489 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16490 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16491 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016492 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016493 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016494 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016495
16496 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016497 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16498 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16499 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016500
16501 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16502 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16503 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016504 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16505 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16506 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16507 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016508
16509 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16510 and processed the connection.
16511
16512 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16513 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16514 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16515 applications.
16516
16517 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16518 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16519 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16520 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16521 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16522
16523 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16524 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16525 See "Timers" below for more details.
16526
16527 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16528 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16529 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16530 "Timers" below for more details.
16531
16532 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016533 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016534 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16535 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16536 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16537 details.
16538
16539 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16540 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16541 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16542 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16543 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16544
16545 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16546 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16547 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16548 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16549 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16550 for more details.
16551
16552 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016553 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016554 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16555 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16556 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016557 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016558
16559 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16560 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16561 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16562 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16563 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16564 caused by a denial of service attack.
16565
16566 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16567 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16568 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16569 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16570 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16571 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16572 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16573 denial of service attack.
16574
16575 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16576 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16577 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16578 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16579 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16580 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16581 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16582 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16583 be processed than on other servers.
16584
16585 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16586 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16587 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16588 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16589 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16590 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16591 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16592 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16593 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16594 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16595 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16596 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16597 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16598
16599 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16600 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16601 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16602 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16603 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16604 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016605 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016606 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16607
16608 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16609 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16610 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16611 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16612 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16613 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016614 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016615 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16616 occurs.
16617
16618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166198.2.3. HTTP log format
16620----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016621
16622The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16623is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16624the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16625are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16626emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16627generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16628"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16629which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016630frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16631is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016632
16633Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16634slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16635with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16636
16637 Example :
16638 frontend http-in
16639 mode http
16640 option httplog
16641 log global
16642 default_backend bck
16643
16644 backend static
16645 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16646
16647 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16648 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16649 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016650 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016651
16652 Field Format Extract from the example above
16653 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16654 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016655 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016656 4 frontend_name http-in
16657 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016658 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016659 7 status_code 200
16660 8 bytes_read* 2750
16661 9 captured_request_cookie -
16662 10 captured_response_cookie -
16663 11 termination_state ----
16664 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16665 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16666 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16667 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16668 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016669
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016670Detailed fields description :
16671 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016672 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16673 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16674 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016675 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016676 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016677 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016678
16679 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016680 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16681 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16682 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016683
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016684 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16685 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016686
16687 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16688 and processed the connection.
16689
16690 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16691 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16692 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16693
16694 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16695 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16696 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16697 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16698 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16699 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16700
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016701 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16702 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16703 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016704 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016705 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16706 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016707 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16708 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016709
16710 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16711 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016712 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713
16714 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16715 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016716 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16717 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016718
16719 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16720 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16721 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16722 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16723 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016724 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16725 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016726
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016727 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16728 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16729 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16730 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16731 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16732 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16733 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016734 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016735
16736 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16737 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16738 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16739
16740 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16741 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016742 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016743 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16744 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16745 overflowing.
16746
16747 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16748 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16749 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16750 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16751 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16752 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16753 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16754 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16755
16756 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16757 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16758 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16759 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16760 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16761 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16762 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16763 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16764
16765 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16766 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16767 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16768 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16769 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16770 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16771 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16772
16773 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016774 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016775 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16776 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16777 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016778 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016779 system.
16780
16781 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16782 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16783 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16784 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16785 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16786 caused by a denial of service attack.
16787
16788 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16789 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16790 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16791 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16792 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16793 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16794 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16795 denial of service attack.
16796
16797 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16798 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16799 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16800 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16801 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16802 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16803 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16804 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16805 processed than on other servers.
16806
16807 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16808 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16809 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16810 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16811 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16812 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16813 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16814 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16815 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16816 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16817 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16818 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16819 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16820
16821 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16822 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16823 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16824 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16825 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16826 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016827 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016828 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16829
16830 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16831 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16832 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16833 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16834 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16835 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016836 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016837 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16838 occurs.
16839
16840 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16841 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16842 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16843 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16844 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16845 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16846 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16847 cookies" below for more details.
16848
16849 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16850 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16851 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16852 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16853 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16854 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16855 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16856 and cookies" below for more details.
16857
16858 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16859 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16860 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16861 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16862 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16863 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16864 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16865 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16866
16867
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168688.2.4. Custom log format
16869------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016870
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016871The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016872mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016873
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016874HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016875Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16876separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16877prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16878
16879Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16880variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016881("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016882
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016883If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016884as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016885less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16886the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16887
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016888Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016889In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016890in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016891
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016892Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16893'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16894https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16895such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16896
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016897Flags are :
16898 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016899 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016900 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16901 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016902
16903 Example:
16904
16905 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16906 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16907
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016908 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16909
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016910At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16911
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016912 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16913 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016914
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016915the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016916
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016917 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16918 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16919 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016920
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016921and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16922
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016923 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16924 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016925
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016926Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16927
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016928 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016929 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016930 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16931 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16932 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016933 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16934 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16935 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016936 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016937 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16938 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016939 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016940 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16941 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016942 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016943 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016944 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016945 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016946 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016947 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016948 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016949 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16950 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16951 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16952 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16953 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016954 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016955 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16956 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016957 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016958 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16959 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016960 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16961 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16962 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016963 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016964 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16965 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016966 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016967 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16968 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16969 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016970 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016971 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016972 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16973 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16974 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16975 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016976 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016977 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016978 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016979 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016980 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016981 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016982 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16983 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16984 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016985 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016986 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16987 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016988 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016989 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16990 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016991 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016992 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016993 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016994 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016995
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016996 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016997
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016998
169998.2.5. Error log format
17000-----------------------
17001
17002When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17003protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17004By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17005"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017006will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017007logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17008
17009The format looks like this :
17010
17011 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17012 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17013 Connection error during SSL handshake
17014
17015 Field Format Extract from the example above
17016 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17017 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17018 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17019 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17020 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17021
17022These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17023failures.
17024
17025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170268.3. Advanced logging options
17027-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017028
17029Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17030just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17031options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17032for more information about their usage.
17033
17034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170358.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17036------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017037
17038It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17039haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17040commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17041monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17042ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17043
17044 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17045 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17046 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17047 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17048
17049 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17050 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17051 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017052 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017053 such as other load-balancers.
17054
17055 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17056 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17057 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17058
17059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170608.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17061----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017062
17063The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17064what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17065or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017066"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017067just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17068log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17069after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17070is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17071with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17072with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17073
17074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170758.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17076------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017077
17078Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17079for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17080"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17081retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17082raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17083a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17084file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17085you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17086"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17087
17088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170898.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17090--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017091
17092Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17093multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17094them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17095"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17096logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17097error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17098and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17099too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17100useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17101alternative.
17102
17103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171048.4. Timing events
17105------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017106
17107Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17108reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17109the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17110frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017111mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17112addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17113
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017114Timings events in HTTP mode:
17115
17116 first request 2nd request
17117 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17118 t tr t tr ...
17119 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17120 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17121 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17122 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17123 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17124
17125Timings events in TCP mode:
17126
17127 TCP session
17128 |<----------------->|
17129 t t
17130 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17131 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17132 |<------ Tt ------->|
17133
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017134 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017135 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017136 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17137 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17138 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017139 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017140 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17141 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17142 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17143 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017144
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017145 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17146 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17147 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017148 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17149 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17150 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17151 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17152 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17153 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017154
17155 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17156 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17157 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17158 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17159 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17160 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17161 request typed by hand during a test.
17162
17163 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17164 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017165 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017166 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17167 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17168 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17169 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017170
17171 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17172 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17173 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17174 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17175 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17176
17177 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17178 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17179 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17180 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17181 connection never established.
17182
17183 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17184 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17185 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17186 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17187 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17188 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17189 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17190 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17191 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17192 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17193 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17194
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017195 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17196 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17197 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17198 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17199 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17200 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17201
17202 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17203
17204 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17205 "Ta" can never be negative.
17206
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017207 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17208 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017209 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17210 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017211 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017212
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017213 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017214
17215 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017216 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17217 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017218
17219These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17220protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17221that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017222due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17223"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17224that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017225
17226Most common cases :
17227
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017228 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17229 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17230 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17231 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17232 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17233 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17234 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17235 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17236 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17237 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17238 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017239 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017240
17241 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17242 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17243 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17244 of ms on remote networks.
17245
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017246 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17247 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17248 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017249
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017250 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17251 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17252 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17253 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17254 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17255 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17256 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17257 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17258 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017259
17260Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17261
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017262 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017263 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017264 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017265
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017266 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017267 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17268 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17269
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017270 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017271 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17272 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17273 flags.
17274
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017275 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17276 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017277 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17278 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17279 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17280 the client connection was maintained open.
17281
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017282 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017283 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017284 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017285 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17286
17287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172888.5. Session state at disconnection
17289-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017290
17291TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17292"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172932-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17294each of which has a special meaning :
17295
17296 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17297 session to terminate :
17298
17299 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17300
17301 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17302 server explicitly refused it.
17303
17304 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17305 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17306 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17307 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017308 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017309
17310 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17311 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017312
17313 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17314 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17315 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17316 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17317 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17318
17319 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17320 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17321 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17322 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17323 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17324
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017325 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17326 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17327
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017328 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17329 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17330 backup connections when going up.
17331
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017332 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17333
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017334 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17335 send or receive data.
17336
17337 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17338 send or receive data.
17339
17340 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17341 with nothing left in the buffers.
17342
17343 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17344
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017345 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017346 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17347
17348 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17349 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17350 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17351 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17352 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17353
17354 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17355 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17356
17357 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17358 server (HTTP only).
17359
17360 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17361
17362 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17363 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17364 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17365
17366 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17367 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17368 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17369
17370 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17371
17372 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17373 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17374
17375 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17376 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17377 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17378
17379 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17380 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017381 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17382 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017383
17384 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17385 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17386 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17387 another server.
17388
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017389 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017390 server.
17391
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017392 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17393 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17394 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17395 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17396
17397 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17398 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17399 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17400 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17401
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017402 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17403 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17404 "use-server" rule).
17405
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017406 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17407
17408 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17409 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17410
17411 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17412
17413 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17414 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17415 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17416
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017417 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17418 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017419 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017420 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17421 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17422
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017423 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17424
17425 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17426 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17427
17428 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17429
17430 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17431
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017432The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17433was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017434helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17435starvation, attacks, etc...
17436
17437The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17438alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17439easier finding and understanding.
17440
17441 Flags Reason
17442
17443 -- Normal termination.
17444
17445 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17446 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17447 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17448 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17449
17450 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17451 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17452 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17453 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17454 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17455 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017456
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017457 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17458 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017459 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017460
17461 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17462 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17463 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17464
17465 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17466 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17467 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17468 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17469 the server takes too long to respond.
17470
17471 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17472 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17473 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17474 long a time to respond.
17475
17476 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17477 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17478 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17479 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017480 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17481 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017482
17483 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17484 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17485 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17486 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17487 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017488 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017489 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17490 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17491 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17492 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17493 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17494 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17495 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17496 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017497 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017498 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17499 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17500 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017501
17502 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17503 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017504 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17505 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17506 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17507 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017508
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017509 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17510 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017512 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017513 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17514 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017515 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017516 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17517 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17518
17519 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17520 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17521 503 or 504 here.
17522
17523 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17524 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17525 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17526 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17527 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17528
17529 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17530 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017531 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017532 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17533 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17534
17535 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17536 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17537 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17538 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17539 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17540 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17541 between haproxy and the server.
17542
17543 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17544 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17545 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17546 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17547 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17548 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17549 solution is to fix the application.
17550
17551 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17552 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17553 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17554 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17555 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17556 external attacks.
17557
17558 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17559 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017560 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017561 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17562 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17563
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017564 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17565 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17566 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017567 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017568 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017569
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017570 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17571 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17572 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17573 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017574 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17575 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17576 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17577 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17578 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017579
17580 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17581 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17582 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17583 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17584
17585 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17586 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17587 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17588 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17589
17590 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17591 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17592 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17593 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17594
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017595The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17596persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17597important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17598re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17599
17600 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17601
17602 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17603 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17604 set on a GET request.
17605
17606 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17607 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017608 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017609 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17610
17611 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17612 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17613 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17614
17615 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17616 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17617 already got a cookie.
17618
17619 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17620 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17621 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17622 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17623 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17624
17625 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17626 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17627 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17628
17629 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17630 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17631 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17632
17633 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17634 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17635
17636 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17637 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17638 then advertised in the response.
17639
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176418.6. Non-printable characters
17642-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017643
17644In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17645consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17646converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17647prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17648being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17649escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17650is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17651'}' when logging headers.
17652
17653Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17654issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17655containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17656
17657Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17658the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17659performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17660
17661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176628.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17663---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017664
17665Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17666achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017667section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017668cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17669the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17670the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017671locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017672not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17673user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17674a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17675wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17676
17677 Examples :
17678 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17679 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17680
17681 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17682 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17683
17684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176858.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17686---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017687
17688Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17689proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17690the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17691server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17692
17693Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17694response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017695section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017696
17697It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017698time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17699appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017700are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17701and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17702follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17703request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17704in the logs.
17705
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017706As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17707frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17708an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17709
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017710 Example :
17711 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17712 listen proxy-out
17713 mode http
17714 option httplog
17715 option logasap
17716 log global
17717 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17718
17719 # log the name of the virtual server
17720 capture request header Host len 20
17721
17722 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17723 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17724
17725 # log the beginning of the referrer
17726 capture request header Referer len 20
17727
17728 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17729 capture response header Server len 20
17730
17731 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17732 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17733
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017734 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017735 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17736
17737 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17738 capture response header Via len 20
17739
17740 # log the URL location during a redirection
17741 capture response header Location len 20
17742
17743 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17744 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17745 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17746 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17747 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17748
17749 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17750 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17751 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17752 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017753 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017754
17755 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17756 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17757 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17758 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17759 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017760 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017761
17762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177638.9. Examples of logs
17764---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017765
17766These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17767them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17768reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17769
17770 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17771 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17772 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17773
17774 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17775 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17776
17777 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17778 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17779 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17780
17781 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17782 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17783
17784 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17785 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17786 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17787
17788 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017789 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017790 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17791 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17792
17793 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17794 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17795 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17796
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017797 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17798 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17799 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17800 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17801 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17802 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017803
17804 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017805 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017806
17807 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17808 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17809 Nothing was sent to any server.
17810
17811 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17812 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17813
17814 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17815 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017816 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017817 send a 408 return code to the client.
17818
17819 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17820 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17821
17822 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17823 5 seconds ("c----").
17824
17825 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17826 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017827 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017828
17829 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017830 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017831 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17832 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17833 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17834 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17835 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017836
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017837
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178389. Supported filters
17839--------------------
17840
17841Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17842accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17843unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17844
17845See also : "filter"
17846
178479.1. Trace
17848----------
17849
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017850filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017851
17852 Arguments:
17853 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17854 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17855
17856 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17857 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17858 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17859 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17860
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017861 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017862 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17863 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17864 amount of the parsed data.
17865
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017866 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017867
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017868This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17869callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17870information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17871filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17872
17873Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17874tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17875a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17876
17877
178789.2. HTTP compression
17879---------------------
17880
17881filter compression
17882
17883The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17884keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017885when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
17886fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
17887done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
17888explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
17889filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
17890listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17891order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017892
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017893See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
17894 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017895
17896
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200178979.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17898--------------------------------------------
17899
17900filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17901
17902 Arguments :
17903
17904 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17905 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17906 parsed.
17907
17908 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17909 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17910 part must be placed in its own scope.
17911
17912The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17913external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017914streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017915exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17916also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17917
17918SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17919the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17920
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017921For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017922"doc/SPOE.txt".
17923
17924Important note:
17925 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17926 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17927
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179289.4. Cache
17929----------
17930
17931filter cache <name>
17932
17933 Arguments :
17934
17935 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17936
17937The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17938"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017939cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017940other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
17941case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
17942is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17943filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017944listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17945order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017946
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017947See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
17948 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
17949
17950
179519.5. Fcgi-app
17952-------------
17953
17954filter fcg-app <name>
17955
17956 Arguments :
17957
17958 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
17959
17960The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
17961request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
17962reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
17963used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
17964implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
17965used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
17966fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
17967used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17968order.
17969
17970See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
17971 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
17972
17973
1797410. FastCGI applications
17975-------------------------
17976
17977HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
17978feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
17979the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
17980FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
17981servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
17982FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
17983backend.
17984
17985HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
17986application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
17987connection.
17988
1798910.1. Setup
17990-----------
17991
1799210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
17993--------------------------
17994
17995fcgi-app <name>
17996 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
17997 document root must be defined.
17998
17999acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18000 Declare or complete an access list.
18001
18002 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18003 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18004 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18005 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18006 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18007
18008docroot <path>
18009 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18010 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18011 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18012
18013index <script-name>
18014 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18015 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18016 is an optional setting.
18017
18018 Example :
18019 index index.php
18020
18021log-stderr global
18022log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18023 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18024 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18025
18026 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18027 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18028
18029pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18030 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18031 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18032 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18033
18034 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18035 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18036 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18037 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18038
18039 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18040 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18041
18042path-info <regex>
18043 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18044 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18045 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18046 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18047 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18048
18049 Example :
18050 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18051
18052option get-values
18053no option get-values
18054 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18055
18056 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18057 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18058
18059 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18060 application will accept.
18061
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018062 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18063 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018064
18065 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18066 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18067 option is disabled.
18068
18069 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18070 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18071 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18072 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18073 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18074 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18075
18076option keep-conn
18077no option keep-conn
18078 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18079 sending a response.
18080
18081 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18082 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18083
18084option max-reqs <reqs>
18085 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18086 accept.
18087
18088 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18089 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18090 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18091 to 1.
18092
18093option mpxs-conns
18094no option mpxs-conns
18095 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18096
18097 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18098 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18099
18100set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18101 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18102 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18103 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18104 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18105
18106 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18107 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18108 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18109
18110 Example :
18111 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18112 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18113
18114 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18115
18116
1811710.1.2. Proxy section
18118---------------------
18119
18120use-fcgi-app <name>
18121 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18122
18123 Arguments :
18124 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18125
18126 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18127 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18128 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18129 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18130 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18131
18132 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18133 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18134 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18135 application are evaluated.
18136
18137
1813810.1.3. Example
18139---------------
18140
18141 frontend front-http
18142 mode http
18143 bind *:80
18144 bind *:
18145
18146 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18147 default_backend back-static
18148
18149 backend back-static
18150 mode http
18151 server www A.B.C.D:80
18152
18153 backend back-dynamic
18154 mode http
18155 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18156 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18157
18158 fcgi-app php-fpm
18159 log-stderr global
18160 option keep-conn
18161
18162 docroot /var/www/my-app
18163 index index.php
18164 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18165
18166
1816710.2. Default parameters
18168------------------------
18169
18170A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18171the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18172scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18173applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18174
18175 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18176 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18177 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18178 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18179 | | |
18180 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18181 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18182 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18183 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18184 | | application. |
18185 | | |
18186 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18187 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18188 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18189 | | |
18190 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18191 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18192 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18193 | | the application's configuration. |
18194 | | |
18195 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18196 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18197 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18198 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18199 | | |
18200 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18201 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18202 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18203 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18204 | | be defined. |
18205 | | |
18206 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18207 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18208 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18209 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18210 | | is not set too. |
18211 | | |
18212 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18213 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18214 | | set. |
18215 | | |
18216 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18217 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18218 | | the request. |
18219 | | |
18220 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18221 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18222 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18223 | | |
18224 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18225 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18226 | | script to process the request. |
18227 | | |
18228 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18229 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18230 | | |
18231 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18232 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18233 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18234 | | |
18235 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18236 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18237 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18238 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18239 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18240 | | |
18241 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18242 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18243 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18244 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18245 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18246 | | side. |
18247 | | |
18248 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18249 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18250 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18251 | | connected to. |
18252 | | |
18253 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18254 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18255 | | |
18256 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18257 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18258 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18259 | | |
18260 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18261
18262
1826310.3. Limitations
18264------------------
18265
18266The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18267way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18268during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18269establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18270application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18271or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18272message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18273these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18274and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18275
18276Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18277request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18278requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18279
18280About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18281into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18282fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18283"http-request" ones.
18284
18285Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18286FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18287processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18288must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18289here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018290
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018291/*
18292 * Local variables:
18293 * fill-column: 79
18294 * End:
18295 */